blob: d2906680b9fa895ff858f40b3e84f5b3d53fe217 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau8c1ad712015-10-06 12:13:56 +02007 2015/10/06
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
1069. Statistics and monitoring
1079.1. CSV format
1089.2. Unix Socket commands
109
110
1111. Quick reminder about HTTP
112----------------------------
113
114When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
115fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
116on almost anything found in the contents.
117
118However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
119formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
120correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
121
122
1231.1. The HTTP transaction model
124-------------------------------
125
126The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100127to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
129connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
130will involve a new connection :
131
132 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
133
134In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
135establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
136by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
137length.
138
139Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
140to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
141however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
142response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
143header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
144
145 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
146
147Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
148power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
149but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200150a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151
152A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
153keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
154second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
155page :
156
157 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
158
159This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
160latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
161correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
162the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100163server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100165By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
166connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
167leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
168start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100170HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
171 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
172 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
173 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
174 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
175 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
176 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
1791.2. HTTP request
180-----------------
181
182First, let's consider this HTTP request :
183
184 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100185 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
187 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
188 3 User-agent: my small browser
189 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
190 5 Accept: image/png
191
192
1931.2.1. The Request line
194-----------------------
195
196Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
197
198 - a METHOD : GET
199 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
200 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
201
202All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
203which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
204followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
205is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
206desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
207the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
208
209The URI itself can have several forms :
210
211 - A "relative URI" :
212
213 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
214
215 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
216 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
217
218 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
219
220 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
221
222 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
223 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
224 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
225 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
226 must accept this form too.
227
228 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
229 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
230 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100231
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200232 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
233 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
234 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
235 other protocols too.
236
237In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
238mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
239on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
240It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
241specific to the language, framework or application in use.
242
243
2441.2.2. The request headers
245--------------------------
246
247The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
248beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
249an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
250Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
251values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
252encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
253the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
254define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
255
256Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
257their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
258"Connection:" header).
259
260The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
261that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
262is one valid form of empty line.
263
264Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
265headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
266about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
267application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
268
269Important note:
270 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
271 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
272 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
273 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
274
275
2761.3. HTTP response
277------------------
278
279An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
280messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
281
282 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100283 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
285 2 Content-length: 350
286 3 Content-Type: text/html
287
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200288As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
289codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
290response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100291continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
292the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
293following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
294sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
295(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
296correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
297such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
298state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
299over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
300if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
301information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200303
3041.3.1. The Response line
305------------------------
306
307Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
308
309 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
310 - a status code : 200
311 - a reason : OK
312
313The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200314 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200315 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
316 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
317 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
318 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
319
320Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100321"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200322found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
323messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
324or "Authentication Required".
325
326Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
327
328 Code When / reason
329 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
330 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
331 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100333 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
334 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200335 400 for an invalid or too large request
336 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
337 accessing the stats page)
338 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
339 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
340 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
341 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
342 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
343 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
344 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
345 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
346 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
347
348The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3494.2).
350
351
3521.3.2. The response headers
353---------------------------
354
355Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
356the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
357details.
358
359
3602. Configuring HAProxy
361----------------------
362
3632.1. Configuration file format
364------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200365
366HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
367
368 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
369 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
370 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
371 "frontend" and "backend".
372
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100373The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
374referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200375delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003782.2. Quoting and escaping
379-------------------------
380
381HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
382many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
383with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
384single quotes.
385
386If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
387them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
388escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
389
390Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
391
392 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
393 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
394 \\ to use a backslash
395 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
396 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
397
398Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
399the interpretation of:
400
401 space as a parameter separator
402 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
403 # hash as a comment start
404
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200405Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
406-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
407backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
408
409Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200410quoting.
411
412Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
413nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
414
415Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
416equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
417
418 Example:
419 # those are equivalents:
420 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
421 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
422 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
423 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
425
426 # those are equivalents:
427 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
428 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
431
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004332.3. Environment variables
434--------------------------
435
436HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
437interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
438configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
439optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
440shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
441underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
442
443 Example:
444
445 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
446
447 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
448
449 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
450
451
4522.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200453----------------
454
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100455Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100456values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
457otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
458numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
459for every keyword. Supported units are :
460
461 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
462 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
463 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
464 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
465 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
466 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
467
468
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004692.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200470-------------
471
472 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
473 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
474 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
475 global
476 daemon
477 maxconn 256
478
479 defaults
480 mode http
481 timeout connect 5000ms
482 timeout client 50000ms
483 timeout server 50000ms
484
485 frontend http-in
486 bind *:80
487 default_backend servers
488
489 backend servers
490 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
491
492
493 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
494 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
495 global
496 daemon
497 maxconn 256
498
499 defaults
500 mode http
501 timeout connect 5000ms
502 timeout client 50000ms
503 timeout server 50000ms
504
505 listen http-in
506 bind *:80
507 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
508
509
510Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
511
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100512 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200513
514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005153. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200516--------------------
517
518Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
519are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
520of them have command-line equivalents.
521
522The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
523
524 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200525 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200527 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200528 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200529 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200530 - description
531 - deviceatlas-json-file
532 - deviceatlas-log-level
533 - deviceatlas-separator
534 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900535 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200536 - gid
537 - group
538 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200539 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100540 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200542 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - pidfile
545 - uid
546 - ulimit-n
547 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200548 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200549 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
550 - ssl-default-bind-options
551 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
552 - ssl-default-server-options
553 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100554 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100555 - unix-bind
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100556 - 51degrees-data-file
557 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200558 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200559 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100560
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200561 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200562 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200563 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200564 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100565 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100566 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100567 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200568 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200569 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200570 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200571 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200572 - noepoll
573 - nokqueue
574 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100575 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300576 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200577 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200578 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200579 - server-state-file
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200580 - tune.buffers.limit
581 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200582 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200583 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100584 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100585 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200586 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100587 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100588 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100589 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100590 - tune.lua.session-timeout
591 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200592 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100593 - tune.maxaccept
594 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200595 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200596 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200597 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100598 - tune.rcvbuf.client
599 - tune.rcvbuf.server
600 - tune.sndbuf.client
601 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100602 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100603 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200604 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100605 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200606 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200607 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200608 - tune.vars.global-max-size
609 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
610 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
611 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100612 - tune.zlib.memlevel
613 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100614
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200615 * Debugging
616 - debug
617 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200618
619
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006203.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200621------------------------------------
622
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200623ca-base <dir>
624 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200625 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
626 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200627
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200628chroot <jail dir>
629 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
630 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
631 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
632 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
633 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
634 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100635
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100636cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
637 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
638 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
639 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100640 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
641 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
642 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
643 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
644 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
645 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
646 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
647 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
648 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
649 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100650
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200651crt-base <dir>
652 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
653 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
654 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
655
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200656daemon
657 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
658 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
659 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
660
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200661deviceatlas-json-file <path>
662 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
663 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
664
665deviceatlas-log-level <value>
666 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
667 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
668
669deviceatlas-separator <char>
670 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
671 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
672
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100673devicatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200674 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
675 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
676 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100677
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900678external-check
679 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
680 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
681 See "option external-check".
682
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200683gid <number>
684 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
685 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
686 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100687 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
688 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200689 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100690
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200691group <group name>
692 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
693 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100694
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200695log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200696 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
697 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100698 configured with "log global".
699
700 <address> can be one of:
701
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100702 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100703 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
704 port).
705
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100706 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
707 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
708 port).
709
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100710 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
711 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
712 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
713 writeable).
714
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200715 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
716 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100717
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200718 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
719 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
720 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
721 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
722 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
723 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
724 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
725 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
726 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
727 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
728 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
729
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200730 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
731 one of the following :
732
733 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
734 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
735
736 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
737 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
738
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100739 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200740
741 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
742 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
743 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
744
745 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200746 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
747 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
748 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
749 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
750 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
751 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200752
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200753 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200754
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100755log-send-hostname [<string>]
756 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
757 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
758 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
759 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
760 the logs.
761
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000762log-tag <string>
763 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
764 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
765 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100766 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000767
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100768lua-load <file>
769 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
770 used multiple times.
771
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200772nbproc <number>
773 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
774 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
775 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
776 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
777 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
778
779pidfile <pidfile>
780 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
781 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
782 starting the process. See also "daemon".
783
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100784stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200785 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
786 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
787 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
788 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
789 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
790 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100791 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200792 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
793 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200794
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200795server-state-base <directory>
796 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200797 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
798 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200799
800server-state-file <file>
801 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
802 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
803 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
804 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
805 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
806 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
807 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
808 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200809 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
810 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200811
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100812ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
813 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
814 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300815 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100816 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
817 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
818 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
819 "bind" keyword for more information.
820
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100821ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
822 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
823 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
824 keyword to see available options.
825
826 Example:
827 global
828 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
829
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100830ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
831 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
832 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300833 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100834 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
835 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
836 information.
837
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100838ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
839 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
840 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
841 keyword to see available options.
842
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200843ssl-dh-param-file <file>
844 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
845 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
846 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
847 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
848 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200849 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
850 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
851 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
852 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200853 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
854 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
855 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
856
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100857ssl-server-verify [none|required]
858 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
859 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
860 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
861
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200862stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
863 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
864 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
865 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
866 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200867
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200868 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
869 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
870 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200871
872stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
873 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
874 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100875 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200876
877stats maxconn <connections>
878 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
879 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
880
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200881uid <number>
882 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
883 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
884 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
885 one. See also "gid" and "user".
886
887ulimit-n <number>
888 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
889 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
890 option.
891
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100892unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
893 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
894
895 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
896 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
897 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
898 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
899 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
900 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
901 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
902 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
903 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
904 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
905
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200906user <user name>
907 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
908 See also "uid" and "group".
909
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200910node <name>
911 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
912
913 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
914 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
915 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
916 traffic.
917
918description <text>
919 Add a text that describes the instance.
920
921 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
922 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
923 "<" and ">" characters.
924
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010092551degrees-data-file <file path>
926 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
927 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
928
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200929 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100930 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
931
93251degrees-property-name-list [<string>]
933 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
934 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
935 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
936
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200937 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100938 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
939
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +020094051degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100941 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
942 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
943
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200944 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
945 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
946
94751degrees-cache-size <number>
948 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
949 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
950 By default, this cache is disabled.
951
952 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100953 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
954
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009563.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200957-----------------------
958
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200959max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
960 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
961 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
962 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
963 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
964 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
965 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
966 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
967 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
968
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200969maxconn <number>
970 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
971 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
972 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200973 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
974 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
975 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
976 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100977 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
978 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
979 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
980 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
981 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200982
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200983maxconnrate <number>
984 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
985 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
986 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
987 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
988 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
989 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
990 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
991 fairness.
992
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100993maxcomprate <number>
994 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300995 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100996 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
997 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
998 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
999 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1000 default value.
1001
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001002maxcompcpuusage <number>
1003 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1004 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1005 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1006 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1007 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1008 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1009 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1010 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1011
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001012maxpipes <number>
1013 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1014 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1015 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1016 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1017 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1018 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1019
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001020maxsessrate <number>
1021 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1022 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1023 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1024 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1025 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1026 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1027 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1028 fairness.
1029
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001030maxsslconn <number>
1031 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1032 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1033 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1034 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1035 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1036 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1037 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001038 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1039 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1040 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1041 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1042 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1043 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1044 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001045
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001046maxsslrate <number>
1047 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1048 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1049 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1050 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1051 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1052 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1053 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1054 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1055 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1056 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1057
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001058maxzlibmem <number>
1059 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1060 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1061 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001062 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1063 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1064 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1065
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001066noepoll
1067 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1068 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001069 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001070
1071nokqueue
1072 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1073 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1074 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1075
1076nopoll
1077 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1078 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001079 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001080 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001081
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001082nosplice
1083 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1084 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1085 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001086 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001087 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1088 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1089 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1090 "option splice-response".
1091
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001092nogetaddrinfo
1093 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1094 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1095
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001096spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001097 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1098 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1099 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1100 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1101 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1102 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001103
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001104tune.buffers.limit <number>
1105 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1106 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1107 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1108 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1109 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1110 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1111 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1112 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1113 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1114 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1115 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1116 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1117 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1118 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1119 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1120
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001121tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1122 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1123 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1124 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1125 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1126
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001127tune.bufsize <number>
1128 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1129 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1130 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1131 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1132 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1133 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1134 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1135 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001136 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1137 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1138 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001139
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001140tune.chksize <number>
1141 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1142 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1143 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1144 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1145 checks whenever possible.
1146
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001147tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1148 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1149 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1150 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1151 this value. The default value is 1.
1152
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001153tune.http.cookielen <number>
1154 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1155 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1156 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1157 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1158 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1159 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1160 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1161 to change this value.
1162
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001163tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1164 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1165 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1166 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1167 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1168 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1169 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1170 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1171 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1172 limit too high.
1173
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001174tune.idletimer <timeout>
1175 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1176 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1177 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1178 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1179 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1180 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1181 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1182 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1183 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1184
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001185tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1186 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
1187 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
1188 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1189 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1190 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1191 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1192 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1193
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001194tune.lua.maxmem
1195 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1196 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1197 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1198 memory.
1199
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001200tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1201 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001202 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1203 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1204 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001205
1206tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1207 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1208 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1209 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1210 check servers.
1211
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001212tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1213 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1214 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1215 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1216 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1217
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001218tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001219 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1220 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1221 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1222 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1223 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1224 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1225 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1226 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1227 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1228 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001229
1230tune.maxpollevents <number>
1231 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1232 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1233 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1234 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1235 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1236
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001237tune.maxrewrite <number>
1238 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1239 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1240 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1241 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1242 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1243 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1244 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1245 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1246 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1247 bufsize.
1248
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001249tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1250 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1251 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1252 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1253 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1254 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1255 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1256 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1257 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1258 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1259 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1260 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1261 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1262 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1263 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1264 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1265 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1266 setting this parameter to 0.
1267
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001268tune.pipesize <number>
1269 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1270 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1271 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1272 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1273 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1274 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1275
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001276tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1277tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1278 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1279 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1280 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1281 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1282 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1283 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1284 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1285
1286tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1287tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1288 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1289 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1290 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1291 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1292 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1293 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1294 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1295 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1296 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1297 notifying haproxy again.
1298
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001299tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001300 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1301 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1302 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001303 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001304 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1305 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1306 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1307 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1308 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001309 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1310 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001311
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001312tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1313 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1314 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1315 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1316 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1317 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1318 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1319
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001320tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1321 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001322 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001323 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1324 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1325 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1326 being used for too long.
1327
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001328tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1329 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1330 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1331 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1332 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1333 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1334 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1335 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1336 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1337 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1338 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001339 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1340 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001341
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001342tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1343 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1344 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1345 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1346 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1347 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1348 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1349 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001350 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1351 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001352
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001353tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1354 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1355 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1356 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1357 1000 entries.
1358
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001359tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
1360tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1361tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1362tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
1363 These four tunes helps to manage the allowed amount of memory used by the
1364 variables system. "global" limits the memory for all the systems. "sess" limit
1365 the memory by session, "txn" limits the memory by transaction and "reqres"
1366 limits the memory for each request or response processing. during the
1367 accounting, "sess" embbed "txn" and "txn" embed "reqres".
1368
1369 By example, we considers that "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is fixed to 100,
1370 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" is fixed to 100, "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" is
1371 also fixed to 100. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1372 we cannot create any more variable in the other contexts.
1373
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001374tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1375 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001376 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001377 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1378 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1379 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1380
1381tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1382 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1383 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1384 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1385 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001386
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013873.3. Debugging
1388--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001389
1390debug
1391 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1392 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1393 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1394 system startup.
1395
1396quiet
1397 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1398 line argument "-q".
1399
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001400
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014013.4. Userlists
1402--------------
1403It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1404http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1405it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1406
1407userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001408 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001409 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1410
1411group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001412 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001413 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1414 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1415
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001416user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1417 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001418 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1419 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001420 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1421 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001422 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001423 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001424
1425
1426 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001427 userlist L1
1428 group G1 users tiger,scott
1429 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001430
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001431 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1432 user scott insecure-password elgato
1433 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001434
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001435 userlist L2
1436 group G1
1437 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001438
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001439 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1440 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1441 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001442
1443 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001444
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001445
14463.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001447----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001448It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1449several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1450instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1451values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1452automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1453In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1454using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1455tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1456reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1457Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1458that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1459each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001460
1461peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001462 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001463 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1464
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001465disabled
1466 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1467 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1468 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1469
1470enable
1471 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1472
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001473peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1474 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1475 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1476 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1477 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1478 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1479 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1480
1481 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1482 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1483
1484 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1485 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1486 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1487 across all peers.
1488
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001489 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1490 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001491
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001492 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001493 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001494 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1495 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1496 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001497
1498 backend mybackend
1499 mode tcp
1500 balance roundrobin
1501 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1502 stick on src
1503
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001504 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1505 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001506
1507
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090015083.6. Mailers
1509------------
1510It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1511If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1512in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1513
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001514mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001515 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1516 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1517
1518mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1519 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1520
1521 Example:
1522 mailers mymailers
1523 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1524 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1525
1526 backend mybackend
1527 mode tcp
1528 balance roundrobin
1529
1530 email-alert mailers mymailers
1531 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1532 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1533
1534 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1535 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1536
1537
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015384. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001539----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001540
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001541Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001542 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001543 - frontend <name>
1544 - backend <name>
1545 - listen <name>
1546
1547A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1548its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1549section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001550section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001551
1552A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1553connections.
1554
1555A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1556to forward incoming connections.
1557
1558A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1559parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1560
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001561All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1562'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1563case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1564
1565Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1566logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1567proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1568However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1569name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1570
1571Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1572and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001573bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001574protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1575modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1576arbitrary criteria.
1577
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001578In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1579a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1580the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1581
1582 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1583 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1584 between responses and new requests.
1585
1586 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1587 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1588 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1589 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1590
1591 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1592 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1593 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1594
1595 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1596 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1597 client-facing connection remains open.
1598
1599 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1600 after the end of the response.
1601
1602The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1603frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1604following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1605weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1606
1607 Backend mode
1608
1609 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1610 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1611 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1612 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1613 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1614 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1615 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1616 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1617 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1618 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1619 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1620
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001621
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001622
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016234.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1624--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001625
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001626The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1627limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1628they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1629limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001630marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001631option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001632and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1633with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1634specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001635
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001636
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001637 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1638------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1639acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001640appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001641backlog X X X -
1642balance X - X X
1643bind - X X -
1644bind-process X X X X
1645block - X X X
1646capture cookie - X X -
1647capture request header - X X -
1648capture response header - X X -
1649clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001650compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001651contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1652cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001653declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001654default-server X - X X
1655default_backend X X X -
1656description - X X X
1657disabled X X X X
1658dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001659email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001660email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001661email-alert mailers X X X X
1662email-alert myhostname X X X X
1663email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001664enabled X X X X
1665errorfile X X X X
1666errorloc X X X X
1667errorloc302 X X X X
1668-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1669errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001670force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001671fullconn X - X X
1672grace X X X X
1673hash-type X - X X
1674http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001675http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001676http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001677http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001678http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001679http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001680http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001681id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001682ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001683load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001684log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001685log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001686log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001687log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001688max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001689maxconn X X X -
1690mode X X X X
1691monitor fail - X X -
1692monitor-net X X X -
1693monitor-uri X X X -
1694option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1695option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1696option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1697option allbackups (*) X - X X
1698option checkcache (*) X - X X
1699option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1700option contstats (*) X X X -
1701option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1702option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1703option forceclose (*) X X X X
1704-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1705option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001706option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001707option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001708option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001709option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001710option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001711option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001712option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001713option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1714option httpchk X - X X
1715option httpclose (*) X X X X
1716option httplog X X X X
1717option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001718option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001719option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001720option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001721option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1722option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1723option logasap (*) X X X -
1724option mysql-check X - X X
1725option nolinger (*) X X X X
1726option originalto X X X X
1727option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001728option pgsql-check X - X X
1729option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001730option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001731option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001732option smtpchk X - X X
1733option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1734option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1735option splice-request (*) X X X X
1736option splice-response (*) X X X X
1737option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1738option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1739-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001740option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001741option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1742option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1743option tcpka X X X X
1744option tcplog X X X X
1745option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001746external-check command X - X X
1747external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001748persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1749rate-limit sessions X X X -
1750redirect - X X X
1751redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1752redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1753reqadd - X X X
1754reqallow - X X X
1755reqdel - X X X
1756reqdeny - X X X
1757reqiallow - X X X
1758reqidel - X X X
1759reqideny - X X X
1760reqipass - X X X
1761reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001762reqitarpit - X X X
1763reqpass - X X X
1764reqrep - X X X
1765-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001766reqtarpit - X X X
1767retries X - X X
1768rspadd - X X X
1769rspdel - X X X
1770rspdeny - X X X
1771rspidel - X X X
1772rspideny - X X X
1773rspirep - X X X
1774rsprep - X X X
1775server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001776server-state-file-name X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001777source X - X X
1778srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02001779stats admin - X X X
1780stats auth X X X X
1781stats enable X X X X
1782stats hide-version X X X X
1783stats http-request - X X X
1784stats realm X X X X
1785stats refresh X X X X
1786stats scope X X X X
1787stats show-desc X X X X
1788stats show-legends X X X X
1789stats show-node X X X X
1790stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001791-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1792stick match - - X X
1793stick on - - X X
1794stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001795stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001796stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001797tcp-check connect - - X X
1798tcp-check expect - - X X
1799tcp-check send - - X X
1800tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001801tcp-request connection - X X -
1802tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001803tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001804tcp-response content - - X X
1805tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001806timeout check X - X X
1807timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001808timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001809timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1810timeout connect X - X X
1811timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1812timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1813timeout http-request X X X X
1814timeout queue X - X X
1815timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001816timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001817timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1818timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001819timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001820transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001821unique-id-format X X X -
1822unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001823use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001824use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001825------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1826 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001827
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001828
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018294.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1830---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001831
1832This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1833
1834
1835acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1836 Declare or complete an access list.
1837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1838 no | yes | yes | yes
1839 Example:
1840 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1841 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1842 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1843
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001844 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001845
1846
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001847appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1848 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001849 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1851 no | no | yes | yes
1852 Arguments :
1853 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1854 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1855
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001856 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001857 checked in each cookie value.
1858
1859 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1860 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1861 milliseconds.
1862
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001863 request-learn
1864 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1865 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1866 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1867 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1868 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1869 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1870
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001871 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1872 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1873 data following this prefix.
1874
1875 Example :
1876 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1877
1878 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1879 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1880
1881 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1882 2 modes are currently supported :
1883 - path-parameters :
1884 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1885 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1886 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1887 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1888 - query-string :
1889 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1890 query string.
1891
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001892 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
1893 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
1894 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001895
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001896 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1897 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001898
1899
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001900backlog <conns>
1901 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1903 yes | yes | yes | no
1904 Arguments :
1905 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1906 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001907 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001908
1909 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1910 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1911 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1912 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1913 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1914 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1915 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1916 backlog parameter.
1917
1918 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1919 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1920 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1921
1922 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1923
1924
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001925balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001926balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001927 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1929 yes | no | yes | yes
1930 Arguments :
1931 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1932 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1933 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1934 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1935
1936 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1937 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1938 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1939 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001940 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001941 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001942 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1943 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1944 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1945 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1946 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1947 it, so that you don't worry.
1948
1949 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1950 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1951 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1952 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1953 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1954 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1955 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1956 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001957
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001958 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1959 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1960 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1961 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1962 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1963 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1964 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1965 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1966
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001967 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001968 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001969 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1970 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001971 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001972 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1973 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1974 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1975 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1976 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001977 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1978 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1979 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1980 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1981 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1982 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001983
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001984 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1985 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1986 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1987 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1988 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1989 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1990 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1991 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001992 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001993 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001994 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1995 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1996 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001997
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001998 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1999 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2000 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2001 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2002 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2003 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2004 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2005 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2006 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2007 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2008 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2009 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002010
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002011 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002012 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2013 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2014 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2015 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2016 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2017 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2018 URIs start with a leading "/".
2019
2020 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2021 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2022 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2023 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2024
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002025 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002026 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2027
2028 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002029 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2030 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002031 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2032 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2033 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2034 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002035 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002036 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2037 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002038
2039 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2040 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2041 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2042 server will receive the request.
2043
2044 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2045 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2046 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2047 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2048 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002049 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2050 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2051 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002052
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002053 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2054 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2055 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2056 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2057 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002058
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002059 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002060 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2061 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2062 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2063
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002064 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2065 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2066 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2067
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002068 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002069 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002070 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2071 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2072 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2073 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2074 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2075 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002076 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002077 used instead.
2078
2079 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2080 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2081 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2082 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2083
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002084 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2085 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2086 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2087
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002088 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002089
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002090 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002091 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2092 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002093
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002094 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2095 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2096 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002097
2098 Examples :
2099 balance roundrobin
2100 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002101 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002102 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2103 balance hdr(host)
2104 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002105
2106 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2107 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2108
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002109 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002110 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2111 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2112 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2113 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2114
2115 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2116 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2117 defaults to 16 kB.
2118
2119 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2120 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2121
2122 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2123 Round Robin.
2124
2125 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2126 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2127 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2128 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2129
2130 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2131
2132 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002133 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002134 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2135 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2136 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002137
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002138 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002139
2140
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002141bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2142bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002143 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2145 no | yes | yes | no
2146 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002147 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2148 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2149 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2150 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002151 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002152 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2153 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2154 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2155 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2156 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2157 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2158 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002159 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2160 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2161 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2162 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2163 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2164 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2165 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002166 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2167 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2168 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002169 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2170 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2171 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002172
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002173 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2174 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002175 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2176 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2177 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002178 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2179 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2180 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2181 the range.
2182
2183 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2184 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2185 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2186 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2187 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2188 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2189 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002190 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002191 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002192
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002193 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2194 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2195 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2196 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2197 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2198 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2199 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2200 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2201
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002202 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2203 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2204 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2205 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002206
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002207 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2208 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2209 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2210 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2211 in a frontend.
2212
2213 Example :
2214 listen http_proxy
2215 bind :80,:443
2216 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002217 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002218
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002219 listen http_https_proxy
2220 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002221 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002222
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002223 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2224 bind ipv6@:80
2225 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2226 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2227
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002228 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002229 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002230
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002231 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2232 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2233 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2234 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2235 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2236
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002237 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002238 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002239
2240
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002241bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002242 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2244 yes | yes | yes | yes
2245 Arguments :
2246 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2247 may be used to override a default value.
2248
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002249 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002250 option may be combined with other numbers.
2251
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002252 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002253 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2254 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2255 missing from all processes.
2256
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002257 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002258 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002259 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2260 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2261 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2262 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002263
2264 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2265 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2266 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2267 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2268 and 'even' instances.
2269
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002270 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2271 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2272 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2273 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002274
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002275 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2276 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2277
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002278 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2279 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2280 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2281
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002282 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2283 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2284
2285 Example :
2286 listen app_ip1
2287 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002288 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002289
2290 listen app_ip2
2291 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002292 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002293
2294 listen management
2295 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002296 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002297
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002298 listen management
2299 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2300 bind-process 1-4
2301
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002302 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002303
2304
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002305block { if | unless } <condition>
2306 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2308 no | yes | yes | yes
2309
2310 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2311 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002312 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002313 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002314 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2315 "block" statements per instance.
2316
2317 Example:
2318 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2319 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2320 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2321 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2322
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002323 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002324
2325
2326capture cookie <name> len <length>
2327 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2329 no | yes | yes | no
2330 Arguments :
2331 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2332 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2333 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2334 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2335 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2336
2337 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2338 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2339 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2340 right if it exceeds <length>.
2341
2342 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2343 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2344 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2345 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2346
2347 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2348 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2349 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2350
2351 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2352 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2353 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002354 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2355 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2356 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002357
2358 Example:
2359 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2360
2361 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002362 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002363
2364
2365capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002366 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2368 no | yes | yes | no
2369 Arguments :
2370 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002371 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002372 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2373 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2374 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2375
2376 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2377 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2378 it exceeds <length>.
2379
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002380 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002381 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2382 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002383 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2384 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2385 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2386 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002387 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002388 environments to find where the request came from.
2389
2390 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2391 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2392 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2393 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002394
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002395 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2396 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2397 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2398 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2399 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002400
2401 Example:
2402 capture request header Host len 15
2403 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2404 capture request header Referrer len 15
2405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002406 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002407 about logging.
2408
2409
2410capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002411 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2413 no | yes | yes | no
2414 Arguments :
2415 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002416 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002417 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2418 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2419 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2420
2421 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2422 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2423 it exceeds <length>.
2424
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002425 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002426 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2427 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2428 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002429 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2430 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2431 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2432 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002433
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002434 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2435 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2436 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2437 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2438 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002439
2440 Example:
2441 capture response header Content-length len 9
2442 capture response header Location len 15
2443
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002444 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002445 about logging.
2446
2447
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002448clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002449 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2451 yes | yes | yes | no
2452 Arguments :
2453 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2454 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2455 as explained at the top of this document.
2456
2457 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2458 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2459 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2460 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2461 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2462 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2463 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2464 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002465 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002466 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2467 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2468
2469 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2470 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2471 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2472 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2473 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2474 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2475
2476 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2477 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2478
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002479 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2480 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002481
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002482compression algo <algorithm> ...
2483compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002484compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002485 Enable HTTP compression.
2486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2487 yes | yes | yes | yes
2488 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002489 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2490 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2491 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2492
2493 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002494 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2495 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2496 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002497
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002498 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2499 support for zlib was built in.
2500
2501 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2502 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2503 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2504 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2505 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
2506 for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002507
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002508 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2509 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2510 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2511 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2512 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2513 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2514 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
2515 available when support for zlib was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002516
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002517 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002518 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002519 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2520 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2521 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2522 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2523 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002524
2525 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2526 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2527 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2528 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2529 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002530 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2531 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2532 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2533 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2534 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002535 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2536 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002537
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002538 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002539 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2540 "Accept-Encoding" header
2541 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002542 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002543 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2544 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002545 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2546 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2547 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2548 "multipart"
2549 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2550 header
2551 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2552 and later
2553 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2554 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002555
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002556 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2557 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002558
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002559 Examples :
2560 compression algo gzip
2561 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002562
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002563contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002564 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2566 yes | no | yes | yes
2567 Arguments :
2568 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2569 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2570 as explained at the top of this document.
2571
2572 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002573 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002574 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002575 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2576 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2577 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2578 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2579
2580 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2581 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2582 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2583 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2584 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2585 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2586
2587 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2588 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2589 instead.
2590
2591 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2592 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2593
2594
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002595cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002596 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2597 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002598 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2600 yes | no | yes | yes
2601 Arguments :
2602 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2603 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2604 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2605 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2606 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2607 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2608 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2609 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2610 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2611
2612 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2613 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2614 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2615 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2616 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2617 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2618 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2619 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2620 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2621 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2622 "insert" and "prefix".
2623
2624 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002625 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002626
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002627 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002628 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2629 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2630 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2631 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2632 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2633 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2634 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2635 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2636 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2637 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002638
2639 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2640 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2641 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2642 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2643 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2644 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2645 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2646 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2647 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2648 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002649 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2650 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2651 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002652
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002653 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2654 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2655 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002656 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2657 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2658 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2659 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002660 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2661 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2662 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002663
2664 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2665 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2666 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2667 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2668 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2669 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2670 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2671 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2672 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2673
2674 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2675 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2676 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2677 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2678 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2679 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2680 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2681 persistence cookie in the cache.
2682 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2683
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002684 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2685 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2686 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2687 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2688 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2689 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2690 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2691 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2692 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2693 they logout.
2694
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002695 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2696 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2697 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2698 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2699
2700 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2701 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2702 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2703 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2704 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2705 this attribute.
2706
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002707 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002708 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002709 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2710 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2711 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2712 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2713 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2714 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002715
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002716 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2717 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2718 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2719 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2720 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2721 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2722 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2723 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2724 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2725 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2726 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2727 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2728 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2729 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2730 the site.
2731
2732 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2733 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2734 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2735 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2736 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2737 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2738 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2739 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2740 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2741 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2742 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2743 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2744 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2745 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2746 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2747 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2748
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002749 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2750 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2751 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2752 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002753
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002754 Examples :
2755 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2756 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2757 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002758 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002759
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002760 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002761
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002762
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002763declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2764 Declares a capture slot.
2765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2766 no | yes | yes | no
2767 Arguments:
2768 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2769
2770 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2771 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2772 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2773 for use in the response.
2774
2775 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
2776 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2777
2778
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002779default-server [param*]
2780 Change default options for a server in a backend
2781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2782 yes | no | yes | yes
2783 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002784 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2785 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2786 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2787 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002788
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002789 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002790 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2791
2792 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002793
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002794
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002795default_backend <backend>
2796 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2798 yes | yes | yes | no
2799 Arguments :
2800 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2801
2802 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2803 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2804 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2805 will catch all undetermined requests.
2806
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002807 Example :
2808
2809 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2810 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2811 default_backend dynamic
2812
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002813 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002814
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002815
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002816description <string>
2817 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2819 no | yes | yes | yes
2820 Arguments : string
2821
2822 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2823 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2824 it describes.
2825 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2826
2827
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002828disabled
2829 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2831 yes | yes | yes | yes
2832 Arguments : none
2833
2834 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2835 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2836 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2837 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2838 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2839 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2840 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2841
2842 See also : "enabled"
2843
2844
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002845dispatch <address>:<port>
2846 Set a default server address
2847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2848 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002849 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002850
2851 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2852 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2853 during start-up.
2854
2855 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2856 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2857 possible with normal servers.
2858
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002859 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002860 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2861 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2862 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2863 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2864
2865 See also : "server"
2866
2867
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002868enabled
2869 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2871 yes | yes | yes | yes
2872 Arguments : none
2873
2874 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2875 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2876
2877 See also : "disabled"
2878
2879
2880errorfile <code> <file>
2881 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2883 yes | yes | yes | yes
2884 Arguments :
2885 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002886 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2887 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002888
2889 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002890 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002891 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002892 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2893 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002894
2895 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2896 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2897 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2898
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002899 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2900
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002901 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2902 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2903 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2904 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2905
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002906 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2907 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2908 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2909 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2910 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2911 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2912
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002913 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2914 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2915 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002916 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002917 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2918
2919 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2920
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002921 Example :
2922 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002923 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002924 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2925 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2926
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002927
2928errorloc <code> <url>
2929errorloc302 <code> <url>
2930 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2932 yes | yes | yes | yes
2933 Arguments :
2934 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002935 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002936
2937 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2938 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2939 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2940 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2941 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2942
2943 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2944 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2945 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2946
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002947 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2948
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002949 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2950 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2951 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2952 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2953 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2954 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2955 request.
2956
2957 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2958
2959
2960errorloc303 <code> <url>
2961 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2963 yes | yes | yes | yes
2964 Arguments :
2965 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2966 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2967
2968 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2969 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2970 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2971 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2972 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2973
2974 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2975 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2976 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2977
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002978 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2979
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002980 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2981 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2982 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2983 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002984 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002985
2986 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2987
2988
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002989email-alert from <emailaddr>
2990 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
2991 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
2992 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2993 yes | yes | yes | yes
2994
2995 Arguments :
2996
2997 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
2998
2999 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3000 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3001
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003002 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003003 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3004 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003005
3006
3007email-alert level <level>
3008 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3009 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3010 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3011 yes | yes | yes | yes
3012
3013 Arguments :
3014
3015 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3016 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3017 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3018
3019 By default level is alert
3020
3021 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3022 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3023 for the proxy.
3024
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003025 Alerts are sent when :
3026
3027 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3028 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3029 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3030 is notice or lower
3031 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3032 and a health check status update occurs
3033
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003034 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3035 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003036 section 3.6 about mailers.
3037
3038
3039email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3040 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3041 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3042 yes | yes | yes | yes
3043
3044 Arguments :
3045
3046 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3047
3048 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3049 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3050
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003051 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3052 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003053
3054
3055email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3056 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3057 mailers.
3058 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3059 yes | yes | yes | yes
3060
3061 Arguments :
3062
3063 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3064
3065 By default the systems hostname is used.
3066
3067 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3068 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3069 for the proxy.
3070
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003071 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3072 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003073
3074
3075email-alert to <emailaddr>
3076 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3077 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3078 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3079 yes | yes | yes | yes
3080
3081 Arguments :
3082
3083 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3084
3085 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3086 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3087
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003088 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003089 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3090
3091
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003092force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3093 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3094 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3095 no | yes | yes | yes
3096
3097 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3098 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3099 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3100 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3101 marked down for maintenance operations.
3102
3103 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3104 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3105 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3106 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3107 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3108 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3109 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3110 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3111 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3112
3113 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3114 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3115 is used.
3116
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003117 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003118 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003119
3120
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003121fullconn <conns>
3122 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3124 yes | no | yes | yes
3125 Arguments :
3126 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3127 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3128
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003129 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003130 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003131 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003132 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3133 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3134 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3135 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3136 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003137 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003138
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003139 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3140 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003141 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3142 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3143 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003144
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003145 Example :
3146 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3147 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3148 # connections.
3149 backend dynamic
3150 fullconn 10000
3151 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3152 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3153
3154 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3155
3156
3157grace <time>
3158 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003160 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003161 Arguments :
3162 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3163 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3164 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3165
3166 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3167 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003168 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003169 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3170
3171 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3172 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3173 simplify it.
3174
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003175
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003176hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003177 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3179 yes | no | yes | yes
3180 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003181 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3182 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003183
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003184 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3185 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3186 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3187 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3188 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3189 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3190 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3191 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3192 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3193 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003194
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003195 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3196 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3197 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3198 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3199 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3200 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3201 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3202 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3203 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3204 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3205 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3206 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3207 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003208 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3209 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003210
3211 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3212
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003213 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003214 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3215 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3216 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003217 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3218 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3219 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003220
3221 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3222 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003223 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3224 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3225 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3226 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3227
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003228 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3229 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3230 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3231 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3232 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3233 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3234 parameter.
3235
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003236 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3237 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3238 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3239 used on strings.
3240
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003241 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3242
3243 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3244 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3245 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3246 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3247 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3248 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3249 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3250 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3251 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3252 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3253 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3254 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003255
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003256 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3257 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3258 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003259
3260 See also : "balance", "server"
3261
3262
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003263http-check disable-on-404
3264 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003266 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003267 Arguments : none
3268
3269 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3270 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3271 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3272 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3273 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3274 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3275 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3276 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003277 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3278 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3279 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3280
3281 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3282
3283
3284http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003285 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003287 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003288 Arguments :
3289 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3290 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003291 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003292 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3293 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3294 details on the supported keywords.
3295
3296 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3297 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3298 with the usual backslash ('\').
3299
3300 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3301 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3302 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3303 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3304 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3305
3306 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003307 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003308 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3309 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3310 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3311
3312 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003313 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003314 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3315 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3316 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3317 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3318
3319 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003320 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003321 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3322 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3323 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3324 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3325 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3326 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3327 trace).
3328
3329 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003330 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003331 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3332 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3333 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3334 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3335 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3336 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3337
3338 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3339 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3340 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3341 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3342 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3343 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3344 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3345 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3346
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003347 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3348 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3349 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3350
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003351 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3352 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3353
3354 Examples :
3355 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003356 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003357
3358 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003359 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003360
3361 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003362 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003363
3364 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003365 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003366
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003367 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003368
3369
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003370http-check send-state
3371 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3373 yes | no | yes | yes
3374 Arguments : none
3375
3376 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3377 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3378 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3379 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3380 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3381
3382 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3383 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3384 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3385 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3386 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003387 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3388 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3389 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3390
3391 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3392 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3393 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3394
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003395 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3396 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3397 checked in multiple backends.
3398
3399 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3400 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3401
3402 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3403 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3404 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3405 one fails.
3406
3407 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3408 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3409 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3410
3411 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3412 server's queue.
3413
3414 Example of a header received by the application server :
3415 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3416 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3417
3418 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3419
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003420http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003421 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003422 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003423 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003424 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3425 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003426 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3427 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003428 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3429 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3430 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003431 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003432 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003433 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003434 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003435 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003436 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003437 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003438 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003439 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3440
3441 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3442 no | yes | yes | yes
3443
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003444 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3445 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3446 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3447 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3448 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003449
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003450 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3451 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3452 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3453
3454 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3455 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
3456 are evaluated.
3457
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003458 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3459 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3460 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3461 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3462 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3463 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3464 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3465 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3466 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003467 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003468 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3469 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003470
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003471 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3472 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3473 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3474 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3475 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3476
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003477 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3478 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3479 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003480 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3481 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003482
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003483 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3484 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3485 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3486 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3487 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3488 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3489 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3490 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3491
3492 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3493 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3494 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003495 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3496 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003497
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003498 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3499 <name>.
3500
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003501 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3502 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3503 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3504 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3505 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3506 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3507 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3508 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3509
3510 Example:
3511
3512 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3513
3514 applied to:
3515
3516 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3517
3518 outputs:
3519
3520 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3521
3522 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3523
3524 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3525 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3526 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3527 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3528 header.
3529
3530 Example:
3531
3532 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3533
3534 applied to:
3535
3536 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3537
3538 outputs:
3539
3540 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3541
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003542 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3543 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3544 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3545 it.
3546
3547 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3548 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3549 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3550 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3551 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3552 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3553
3554 Example :
3555 # prepend the host name before the path
3556 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3557
3558 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3559 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3560 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3561 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3562 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3563 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3564 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3565 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3566
3567 Example :
3568 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3569 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3570
3571 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3572 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3573 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3574 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3575 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3576 "set-query".
3577
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003578 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3579 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3580 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3581 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3582 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3583 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3584 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3585 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3586
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003587 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3588 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3589 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3590 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3591 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3592 another equipment.
3593
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003594 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3595 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3596 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3597 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3598 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3599 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3600 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3601 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3602
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003603 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3604 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3605 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3606 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3607 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3608 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3609 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3610 admin privileges.
3611
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003612 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3613 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3614 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3615 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3616 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3617 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3618 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3619 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3620
3621 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3622 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3623 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3624 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3625 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3626 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3627
3628 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3629 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3630 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3631 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3632 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3633 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3634
3635 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3636 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3637 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3638 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3639 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3640 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3641 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3642 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3643 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3644
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003645 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003646 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3647 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3648 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3649 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3650 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3651 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3652 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3653 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3654 request header" for more information.
3655
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003656 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3657 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3658 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3659 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
3660
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003661 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3662 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3663 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3664 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3665 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3666 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3667 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3668 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3669 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3670 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3671 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3672 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3673
3674 These actions take one or two arguments :
3675 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3676 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3677 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3678 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3679
3680 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3681 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3682 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3683 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3684
3685 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3686 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3687 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3688 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3689 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3690 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3691 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3692 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3693
3694 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3695 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3696 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3697 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3698 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3699
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003700 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3701 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3702 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3703 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3704 continues.
3705
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003706 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3707 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3708 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
3709 the actions evaluation continues.
3710
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003711 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3712 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3713 inline.
3714
3715 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
3716 scope. The allowed scopes are:
3717 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
3718 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
3719 (request and response)
3720 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
3721 processing
3722 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
3723 processing.
3724 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
3725 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
3726 and '_'.
3727
3728 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3729 followed by some converters.
3730
3731 Example:
3732
3733 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
3734
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003735 - set-src <expr> :
3736 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
3737 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
3738 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3739 source IP for privacy.
3740
3741 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3742 followed by some converters.
3743
3744 Example:
3745
3746 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
3747 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
3748
3749 When set-src is successful, the source port is set to 0.
3750
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003751 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
3752 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
3753 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
3754 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
3755 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
3756 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
3757 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
3758 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
3759 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
3760 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
3761 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
3762 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
3763 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
3764 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
3765 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
3766 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
3767
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003768 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3769
3770 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3771 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3772 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3773 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003774
3775 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003776 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3777 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3778 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003779
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003780 http-request allow if nagios
3781 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3782 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3783 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003784
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003785 Example:
3786 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003787 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003788
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003789 Example:
3790 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3791 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02003792 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003793 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3794 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3795 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3796 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3797 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3798 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3799
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003800 Example:
3801 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3802 acl add path /addacl
3803 acl del path /delacl
3804
3805 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3806
3807 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3808 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3809
3810 Example:
3811 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3812 acl setmap path /setmap
3813 acl delmap path /delmap
3814
3815 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3816
3817 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3818 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3819
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003820 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3821 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003822
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003823http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003824 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003825 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003826 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3827 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02003828 set-status <status> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003829 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3830 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3831 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3832 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003833 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003834 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003835 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003836 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003837 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003838 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003839 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003840 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3841
3842 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3843 no | yes | yes | yes
3844
3845 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3846 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3847 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3848 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3849 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3850 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3851
3852 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3853 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3854 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3855 current section.
3856
3857 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3858 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3859 rules are evaluated.
3860
3861 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3862 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3863 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3864 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3865 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3866 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3867 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3868
3869 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3870 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3871 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3872 external users.
3873
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003874 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3875 <name>.
3876
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003877 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3878 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3879 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3880 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3881 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3882 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3883 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3884 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3885
3886 Example:
3887
3888 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3889
3890 applied to:
3891
3892 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3893
3894 outputs:
3895
3896 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3897
3898 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3899
3900 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3901 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3902 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3903 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3904 header.
3905
3906 Example:
3907
3908 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3909
3910 applied to:
3911
3912 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3913
3914 outputs:
3915
3916 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3917
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02003918 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
3919 be an integer between 100 and 999. Note that the reason is automatically
3920 adapted to the new code.
3921
3922 Example:
3923
3924 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
3925 http-response set-status 431
3926
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003927 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3928 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3929 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3930 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3931 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3932 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3933 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3934 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3935
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003936 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3937 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3938 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3939 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3940 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3941 another equipment.
3942
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003943 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3944 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3945 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3946 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3947 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3948 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3949 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3950 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3951
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003952 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3953 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3954 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3955 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3956 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3957 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3958 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3959 admin privileges.
3960
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003961 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3962 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3963 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3964 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3965 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3966 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3967 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3968 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3969
3970 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3971 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3972 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3973 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3974 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3975 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3976
3977 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3978 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3979 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3980 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3981 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3982 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3983
3984 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3985 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3986 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3987 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3988 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3989 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3990 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3991 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3992 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3993
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02003994 - capture <sample> id <id> :
3995 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
3996 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
3997 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
3998 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
3999 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4000 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4001 response header" for more information.
4002
4003 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4004 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4005 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4006 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4007 keyword.
4008
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004009 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4010 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4011 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4012 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4013 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4014 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4015
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004016 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4017 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4018 inline.
4019
4020 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
4021 scope. The allowed scopes are:
4022 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
4023 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
4024 (request and response)
4025 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
4026 processing
4027 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
4028 processing.
4029 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4030 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4031 and '_'.
4032
4033 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4034 followed by some converters.
4035
4036 Example:
4037
4038 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4039
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004040 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4041 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4042 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4043 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4044 continues.
4045
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004046 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4047 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4048 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4049 the actions evaluation continues.
4050
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004051 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4052 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4053 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4054 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4055 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4056 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4057 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4058 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4059 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4060 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4061 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4062 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4063 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4064 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4065 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4066 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4067
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004068 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4069
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004070 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004071 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
4072 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
4073 rules.
4074
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004075 Example:
4076 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4077
4078 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4079
4080 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4081 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4082
4083 Example:
4084 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4085
4086 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4087
4088 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4089 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4090
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004091 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4092 ACL usage.
4093
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004094
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004095http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4096 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4097
4098 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4099 yes | no | yes | yes
4100
4101 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4102 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4103 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4104 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4105 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4106 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4107
4108 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4109
4110 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4111 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4112 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4113 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4114 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4115 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4116 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4117 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4118 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4119 not checking any request past the first one.
4120
4121 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4122 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4123 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4124 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4125 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4126 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4127 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4128
4129 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4130 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4131 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4132 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4133 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4134 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4135 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4136 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4137 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4138 downsides of rare connection failures.
4139
4140 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4141 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4142 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4143 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4144 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4145 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4146 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4147 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4148 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4149 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4150 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4151 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4152
4153 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4154 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4155 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4156 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4157
4158 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4159 and are never shared ;
4160
4161 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4162 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4163 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4164 and are never shared ;
4165
4166 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4167 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4168 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4169
4170 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4171 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4172 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4173
4174 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4175
4176
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004177http-send-name-header [<header>]
4178 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4179
4180 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4181 yes | no | yes | yes
4182
4183 Arguments :
4184
4185 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4186
4187 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4188 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4189 is added with the header string proved.
4190
4191 See also : "server"
4192
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004193id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004194 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4196 no | yes | yes | yes
4197 Arguments : none
4198
4199 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4200 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4201 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004202
4203
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004204ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4205 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4206 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4207 no | yes | yes | yes
4208
4209 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4210 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4211 and running).
4212
4213 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4214 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4215 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004216 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004217 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4218
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004219 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4220 "unless" condition is met.
4221
4222 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4223
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004224load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4225 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4226 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4227 yes | no | yes | yes
4228
4229 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4230 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4231 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4232 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4233 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4234 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4235 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4236 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4237
4238 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4239 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
4240 9.2).
4241
4242 Arguments:
4243 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4244 named "server-state-file".
4245
4246 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4247 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4248 name is used as a file name.
4249
4250 none don't load any stat for this backend
4251
4252 Notes:
4253 - server's IP address is not updated unless DNS resolution is enabled on
4254 the server. It means that if a server IP address has been changed using
4255 the stat socket, this information won't be re-applied after reloading.
4256
4257 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4258 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4259
4260 Example 1:
4261
4262 Minimal configuration:
4263
4264 global
4265 stats socket /tmp/socket
4266 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
4267
4268 defaults
4269 load-server-state-from-file global
4270
4271 backend bk
4272 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4273 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4274
4275 Then one can run :
4276
4277 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4278
4279 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4280
4281 1
4282 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4283 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4284 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4285
4286 Example 2:
4287
4288 Minimal configuration:
4289
4290 global
4291 stats socket /tmp/socket
4292 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4293
4294 defaults
4295 load-server-state-from-file local
4296
4297 backend bk
4298 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4299 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4300
4301 Then one can run :
4302
4303 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4304
4305 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4306
4307 1
4308 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4309 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4310 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4311
4312 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4313 "show servers state"
4314
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004315
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004316log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004317log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004318no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004319 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4321 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004322
4323 Prefix :
4324 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4325 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4326 prefix does not allow arguments.
4327
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004328 Arguments :
4329 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4330 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4331 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4332 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4333 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4334 parameter.
4335
4336 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4337 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4338
4339 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4340 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4341 standard syslog port).
4342
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004343 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4344 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4345 standard syslog port).
4346
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004347 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4348 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4349 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4350 appropriately writeable).
4351
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004352 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4353 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004354
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004355 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4356 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4357 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4358 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4359 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4360 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4361 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4362 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4363 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4364 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4365 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4366
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004367 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4368
4369 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4370 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4371 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4372
4373 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4374 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4375 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004376 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4377 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4378 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4379 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4380 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004381
4382 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4383
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004384 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4385 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4386 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004387
4388 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4389 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4390 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4391 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4392
4393 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4394 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004395
4396 Example :
4397 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004398 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4399 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004400 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004401
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004402
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004403log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004404 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4405 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4406 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004407
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004408 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4409 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4410 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4411 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4412 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004413
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004414log-format-sd <string>
4415 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4416 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4417 yes | yes | yes | no
4418
4419 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4420 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4421 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4422 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4423 which covers the log format string in depth.
4424
4425 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4426 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4427
4428 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4429 log format to "rfc5424".
4430
4431 Example :
4432 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4433
4434
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004435log-tag <string>
4436 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4437 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4438 yes | yes | yes | yes
4439
4440 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4441 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4442 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4443 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4444 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4445 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4446 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4447 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4448 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004449
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004450max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4451 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4452 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4453 yes | no | yes | yes
4454
4455 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4456 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4457 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4458 servers.
4459
4460 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4461 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4462 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4463 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4464 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4465 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4466 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4467 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4468 picking a different server.
4469
4470 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4471 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4472 even if they have to be queued.
4473
4474 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4475 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4476
4477
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004478maxconn <conns>
4479 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4481 yes | yes | yes | no
4482 Arguments :
4483 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4484 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4485 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4486 closes.
4487
4488 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4489 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4490 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4491 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
4492 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
4493 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
4494 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
4495 properly tuned.
4496
4497 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4498 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4499 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4500
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004501 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4502
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004503 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4504
4505
4506mode { tcp|http|health }
4507 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4509 yes | yes | yes | yes
4510 Arguments :
4511 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4512 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4513 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4514 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4515
4516 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4517 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4518 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4519 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4520 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4521
4522 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004523 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4524 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4525 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4526 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4527 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4528 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4529 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004530
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004531 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4532 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4533 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004534
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004535 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004536 defaults http_instances
4537 mode http
4538
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004539 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004540
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004541
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004542monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004543 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4545 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004546 Arguments :
4547 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4548 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004549 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004550 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4551 backend and its backup.
4552
4553 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4554 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4555 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4556 servers in a list of backends.
4557
4558 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4559 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4560 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4561 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4562 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4563 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4564 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004565 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4566 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004567
4568 Example:
4569 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004570 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004571 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4572 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4573 monitor-uri /site_alive
4574 monitor fail if site_dead
4575
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004576 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004577
4578
4579monitor-net <source>
4580 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4582 yes | yes | yes | no
4583 Arguments :
4584 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4585 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4586 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4587 followed by a mask.
4588
4589 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4590 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004591 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004592 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4593
4594 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4595 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4596 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4597 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004598 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4599 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4600 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004601
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004602 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4603 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4604 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4605 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4606 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4607 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004608
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004609 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4610 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004611
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004612 Example :
4613 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4614 frontend www
4615 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4616
4617 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4618
4619
4620monitor-uri <uri>
4621 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4623 yes | yes | yes | no
4624 Arguments :
4625 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4626 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4627
4628 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4629 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4630 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4631 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4632 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4633 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4634 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4635 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4636
4637 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4638 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4639 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4640 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4641 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4642 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4643
4644 Example :
4645 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4646 frontend www
4647 mode http
4648 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4649
4650 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4651
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004652
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004653option abortonclose
4654no option abortonclose
4655 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4657 yes | no | yes | yes
4658 Arguments : none
4659
4660 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4661 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4662 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4663 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004664 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004665 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4666 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4667 encountered while delivering the response.
4668
4669 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4670 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4671 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4672 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4673 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4674 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004675 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004676 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004677 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004678 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4679 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4680 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4681
4682 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4683 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4684 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4685 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4686 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4687 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4688 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4689 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004690 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004691
4692 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4693 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4694
4695 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4696
4697
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004698option accept-invalid-http-request
4699no option accept-invalid-http-request
4700 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4702 yes | yes | yes | no
4703 Arguments : none
4704
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004705 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004706 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4707 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4708 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4709 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4710 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4711 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4712 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004713 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4714 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4715 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4716 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4717 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004718 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02004719 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
4720 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
4721 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004722
4723 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4724 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4725 been confirmed.
4726
4727 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4728 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004729 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4730 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004731 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4732
4733 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4734 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4735
4736 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4737 stats socket.
4738
4739
4740option accept-invalid-http-response
4741no option accept-invalid-http-response
4742 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4744 yes | no | yes | yes
4745 Arguments : none
4746
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004747 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004748 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4749 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4750 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4751 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4752 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4753 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4754 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004755 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
4756 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
4757 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004758
4759 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4760 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4761 been confirmed.
4762
4763 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4764 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4765 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4766 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4767
4768 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4769 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4770
4771 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4772 stats socket.
4773
4774
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004775option allbackups
4776no option allbackups
4777 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4779 yes | no | yes | yes
4780 Arguments : none
4781
4782 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4783 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4784 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4785 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4786 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4787 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4788 order between the backup servers anymore.
4789
4790 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4791 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4792
4793 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4794 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4795
4796
4797option checkcache
4798no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004799 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4801 yes | no | yes | yes
4802 Arguments : none
4803
4804 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4805 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004806 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004807 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4808 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004809 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004810
4811 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004812 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004813 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004814 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4815 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004816 to the client are :
4817 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004818 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004819 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004820 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4821 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4822 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4823 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4824 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4825 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4826 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4827 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4828 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4829 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4830 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4831
4832 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004833 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004834 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004835 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004836 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
4837
4838 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
4839 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004840 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004841 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
4842
4843 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4844 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4845
4846
4847option clitcpka
4848no option clitcpka
4849 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
4850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4851 yes | yes | yes | no
4852 Arguments : none
4853
4854 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4855 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4856 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4857 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4858
4859 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4860 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4861 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4862 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4863
4864 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4865 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4866 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4867 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4868 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4869
4870 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4871
4872 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4873 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4874 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
4875
4876 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4877 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4878
4879 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
4880
4881
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004882option contstats
4883 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
4884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4885 yes | yes | yes | no
4886 Arguments : none
4887
4888 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
4889 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
4890 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
4891 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
4892 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
4893 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
4894 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
4895
4896
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004897option dontlog-normal
4898no option dontlog-normal
4899 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
4900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4901 yes | yes | yes | no
4902 Arguments : none
4903
4904 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
4905 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
4906 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
4907 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
4908 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
4909 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
4910 logged.
4911
4912 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
4913 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
4914 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
4915
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004916 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004917 logging.
4918
4919
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004920option dontlognull
4921no option dontlognull
4922 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4924 yes | yes | yes | no
4925 Arguments : none
4926
4927 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4928 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4929 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4930 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4931 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4932 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004933 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
4934 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
4935 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004936
4937 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
4938 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4939 would not be logged.
4940
4941 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4942 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4943
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02004944 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
4945 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004946
4947
4948option forceclose
4949no option forceclose
4950 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004952 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004953 Arguments : none
4954
4955 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4956 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4957 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4958 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4959 global session times in the logs.
4960
4961 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004962 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004963 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004964
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004965 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4966 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4967 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4968
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004969 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4970 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004971
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004972 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4973 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4974
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004975 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004976
4977
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004978option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004979 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4981 yes | yes | yes | yes
4982 Arguments :
4983 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4984 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004985 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004986 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004987
4988 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4989 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4990 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4991 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4992 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4993 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4994 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004995 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4996 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4997 possible that the client has already brought one.
4998
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004999 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005000 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005001 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5002 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005003 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5004 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005005
5006 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5007 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5008 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5009 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5010 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5011 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5012 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5013
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005014 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5015 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5016 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5017 are under the control of the end-user.
5018
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005019 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005020 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5021 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005022 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5023 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5024 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005025
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005026 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005027 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5028 frontend www
5029 mode http
5030 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5031
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005032 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5033 backend www
5034 mode http
5035 option forwardfor header X-Client
5036
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005037 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005038 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005039
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005040
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005041option http-buffer-request
5042no option http-buffer-request
5043 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5045 yes | yes | yes | yes
5046 Arguments : none
5047
5048 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5049 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5050 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5051 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5052 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5053 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5054 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5055 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
5056 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
5057 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5058 default.
5059
5060 See also : "option http-no-delay"
5061
5062
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005063option http-ignore-probes
5064no option http-ignore-probes
5065 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5067 yes | yes | yes | no
5068 Arguments : none
5069
5070 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5071 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5072 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5073 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5074 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5075 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5076 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5077 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5078 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5079 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5080 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5081 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5082
5083 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5084 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5085 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5086 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5087 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5088 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5089 are often the only way to detect them.
5090
5091 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5092 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5093
5094 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5095
5096
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005097option http-keep-alive
5098no option http-keep-alive
5099 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5101 yes | yes | yes | yes
5102 Arguments : none
5103
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005104 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5105 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5106 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5107 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5108 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5109 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5110 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5111
5112 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5113 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005114 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5115 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5116 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5117 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5118 situations where this option may be useful :
5119
5120 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5121 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5122
5123 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5124 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5125
5126 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5127 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5128 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5129 request.
5130
5131 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5132 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005133 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5134 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5135 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005136
5137 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5138 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5139
5140 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5141 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5142 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5143 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5144 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5145 not set.
5146
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005147 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5148 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005149 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005150 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005151
5152 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005153 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5154 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005155
5156
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005157option http-no-delay
5158no option http-no-delay
5159 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5161 yes | yes | yes | yes
5162 Arguments : none
5163
5164 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5165 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5166 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5167 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5168 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5169 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5170 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5171 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5172 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5173 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5174 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5175 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5176 affected.
5177
5178 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5179 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5180 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5181 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5182 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5183 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5184 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5185 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5186 latency environments.
5187
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005188 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5189
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005190
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005191option http-pretend-keepalive
5192no option http-pretend-keepalive
5193 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5195 yes | yes | yes | yes
5196 Arguments : none
5197
5198 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5199 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5200 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5201 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5202 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5203 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5204 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5205 consider the response complete.
5206
5207 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5208 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5209 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5210 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5211 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5212 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5213
5214 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5215 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5216 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5217 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5218 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5219 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5220 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5221
5222 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5223 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005224 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005225 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5226 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005227
5228 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5229 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5230
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005231 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5232 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005233
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005234
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005235option http-server-close
5236no option http-server-close
5237 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5239 yes | yes | yes | yes
5240 Arguments : none
5241
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005242 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5243 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5244 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5245 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5246 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5247 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5248 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5249 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5250 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5251 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5252 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5253 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5254 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5255 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5256 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5257 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005258
5259 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5260 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5261 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5262 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005263 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5264 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005265
5266 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5267 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005268 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5269 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005270 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5271 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005272
5273 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5274 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5275
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005276 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005277 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5278 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005279
5280
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005281option http-tunnel
5282no option http-tunnel
5283 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5285 yes | yes | yes | yes
5286 Arguments : none
5287
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005288 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5289 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5290 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5291 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5292 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5293 "option http-tunnel".
5294
5295 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005296 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005297 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5298 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5299 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5300 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5301 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5302 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5303 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005304
5305 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5306 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5307
5308 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5309 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5310 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5311
5312
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005313option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005314no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005315 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5317 yes | yes | yes | no
5318 Arguments : none
5319
5320 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5321 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5322 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5323 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5324 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5325 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5326 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5327
5328 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5329 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
5330 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
5331 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
5332 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
5333 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
5334 request along its whole life.
5335
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005336 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5337 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5338 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5339 front of an existing proxy.
5340
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005341 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5342
5343 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5344 http-server-close".
5345
5346
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005347option httpchk
5348option httpchk <uri>
5349option httpchk <method> <uri>
5350option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5351 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5353 yes | no | yes | yes
5354 Arguments :
5355 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5356 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5357 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5358 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5359 ones.
5360
5361 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5362 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5363 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5364
5365 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5366 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5367 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5368 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5369 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5370
5371 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5372 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5373 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5374 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5375 the lack of any response.
5376
5377 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5378
5379 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5380 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5381 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5382
5383 Examples :
5384 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5385 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5386 backend https_relay
5387 mode tcp
5388 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5389 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5390
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005391 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5392 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5393 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005394
5395
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005396option httpclose
5397no option httpclose
5398 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5400 yes | yes | yes | yes
5401 Arguments : none
5402
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005403 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5404 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5405 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5406 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005407 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005408 "option http-tunnel".
5409
5410 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5411 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5412 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5413 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5414 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5415 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5416 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5417 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005418
5419 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005420 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005421 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5422 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5423 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5424 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5425 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005426
5427 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5428 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005429 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5430 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005431 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5432 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005433
5434 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5435 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5436
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005437 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5438 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005439
5440
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005441option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005442 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5444 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005445 Arguments :
5446 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5447 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5448 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5449 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5450 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005451
5452 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5453 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5454 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5455 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5456 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5457 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5458 ports.
5459
5460 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5461
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005462 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5463 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005464
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005465 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005466
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005467
5468option http_proxy
5469no option http_proxy
5470 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5472 yes | yes | yes | yes
5473 Arguments : none
5474
5475 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5476 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5477 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5478 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5479 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5480
5481 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5482 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
5483 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
5484 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01005485 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005486 be analyzed.
5487
5488 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5489 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5490
5491 Example :
5492 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5493 backend direct_forward
5494 option httpclose
5495 option http_proxy
5496
5497 See also : "option httpclose"
5498
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005499
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005500option independent-streams
5501no option independent-streams
5502 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5504 yes | yes | yes | yes
5505 Arguments : none
5506
5507 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5508 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5509 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5510 receive data or not.
5511
5512 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5513 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5514 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5515 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5516 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5517 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5518 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5519 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5520 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5521 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5522 socket buffers.
5523
5524 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5525 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5526 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5527 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5528 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5529
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005530 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005531 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5532 deprecated.
5533
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005534 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005535
5536
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005537option ldap-check
5538 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5540 yes | no | yes | yes
5541 Arguments : none
5542
5543 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5544 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5545 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5546 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5547
5548 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5549 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5550
5551 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5552 configure it.
5553
5554 Example :
5555 option ldap-check
5556
5557 See also : "option httpchk"
5558
5559
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005560option external-check
5561 Use external processes for server health checks
5562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5563 yes | no | yes | yes
5564
5565 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5566 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5567 command".
5568
5569 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5570
5571 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5572
5573
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005574option log-health-checks
5575no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005576 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5578 yes | no | yes | yes
5579 Arguments : none
5580
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005581 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5582 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5583 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005584
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005585 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5586 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5587 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5588 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5589 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5590
5591 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5592 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005593
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005594 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5595 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5596 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005597
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005598
5599option log-separate-errors
5600no option log-separate-errors
5601 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5603 yes | yes | yes | no
5604 Arguments : none
5605
5606 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5607 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5608 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5609 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5610 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5611 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5612 provides very important information.
5613
5614 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5615 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5616 error logs.
5617
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005618 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005619 logging.
5620
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005621
5622option logasap
5623no option logasap
5624 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5626 yes | yes | yes | no
5627 Arguments : none
5628
5629 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5630 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5631 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5632 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5633 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5634 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5635 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005636 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005637 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5638 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5639
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005640 Examples :
5641 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5642 mode http
5643 option httplog
5644 option logasap
5645 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5646
5647 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5648 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5649 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5650 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5651
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005652 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005653 logging.
5654
5655
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005656option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005657 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5659 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005660 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005661 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5662 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005663 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005664
5665 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5666 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5667 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5668 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5669 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5670 in the MySQL table, like this :
5671
5672 USE mysql;
5673 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5674 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5675
5676 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5677 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5678 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5679 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5680 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5681 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5682 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5683 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5684 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5685
5686 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5687 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005688
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005689 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005690
5691 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5692 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5693 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5694 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02005695 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
5696 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005697
5698 See also: "option httpchk"
5699
5700
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005701option nolinger
5702no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005703 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005704 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5705 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005706 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005707
5708 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5709 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5710 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5711 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5712 connections.
5713
5714 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5715 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5716 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5717 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5718 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5719 this too.
5720
5721 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5722 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5723 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5724
5725 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5726 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5727 for servers.
5728
5729 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5730 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5731
5732
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005733option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5734 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5736 yes | yes | yes | yes
5737 Arguments :
5738 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5739 matching <network>
5740 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5741 header name.
5742
5743 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5744 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5745 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5746 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5747 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5748 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5749 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5750 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5751 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5752 possible that the client has already brought one.
5753
5754 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5755 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5756 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5757 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5758 header and requires different one.
5759
5760 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5761 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5762 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5763 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5764 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5765 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5766 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5767
5768 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5769 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5770 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5771 both are defined.
5772
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005773 Examples :
5774 # Original Destination address
5775 frontend www
5776 mode http
5777 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5778
5779 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5780 backend www
5781 mode http
5782 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5783
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005784 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5785 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005786
5787
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005788option persist
5789no option persist
5790 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5791 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5792 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005793 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005794
5795 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5796 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5797 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5798 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5799 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5800 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5801 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5802 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5803 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5804 redirected to another valid server.
5805
5806 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5807 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5808
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005809 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005810
5811
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005812option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5813 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5815 yes | no | yes | yes
5816 Arguments :
5817 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5818 PostgreSQL server.
5819
5820 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5821 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5822 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5823 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5824
5825 See also: "option httpchk"
5826
5827
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005828option prefer-last-server
5829no option prefer-last-server
5830 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5831 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5832 yes | no | yes | yes
5833 Arguments : none
5834
5835 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5836 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5837 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5838 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5839 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
5840 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
5841 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
5842 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
5843 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01005844 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
5845 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
5846 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
5847 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
5848 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
5849 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
5850 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005851
5852 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5853 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5854
5855 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
5856
5857
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005858option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005859option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005860no option redispatch
5861 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5862 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5863 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005864 Arguments :
5865 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
5866 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
5867 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
5868 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
5869 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
5870 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
5871 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
5872 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
5873 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
5874
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005875
5876 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5877 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5878 be able to access the service anymore.
5879
5880 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
5881 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
5882
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005883 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005884 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5885 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005886
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005887 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
5888 "redisp" keywords.
5889
5890 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5891 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5892
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005893 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005894
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005895
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02005896option redis-check
5897 Use redis health checks for server testing
5898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5899 yes | no | yes | yes
5900 Arguments : none
5901
5902 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
5903 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
5904 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
5905 find the "+PONG" response message.
5906
5907 Example :
5908 option redis-check
5909
5910 See also : "option httpchk"
5911
5912
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005913option smtpchk
5914option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
5915 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
5916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5917 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005918 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005919 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
5920 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
5921 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
5922
5923 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
5924 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
5925 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
5926
5927 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
5928 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
5929 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
5930 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
5931 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
5932 dead server.
5933
5934 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
5935 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
5936 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
5937 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
5938
5939 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
5940 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
5941 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5942 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02005943 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005944
5945 Example :
5946 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
5947
5948 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
5949
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005950
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02005951option socket-stats
5952no option socket-stats
5953
5954 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
5955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5956 yes | yes | yes | no
5957
5958 Arguments : none
5959
5960
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005961option splice-auto
5962no option splice-auto
5963 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
5964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5965 yes | yes | yes | yes
5966 Arguments : none
5967
5968 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
5969 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
5970 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
5971 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005972 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005973 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
5974 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
5975 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
5976 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5977
5978 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
5979 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
5980 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
5981 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
5982 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
5983 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
5984 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
5985 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
5986 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
5987 keyword.
5988
5989 Example :
5990 option splice-auto
5991
5992 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5993 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5994
5995 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5996 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5997
5998
5999option splice-request
6000no option splice-request
6001 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6003 yes | yes | yes | yes
6004 Arguments : none
6005
6006 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006007 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006008 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6009 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6010 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6011 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6012
6013 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6014
6015 Example :
6016 option splice-request
6017
6018 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6019 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6020
6021 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6022 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6023
6024
6025option splice-response
6026no option splice-response
6027 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6029 yes | yes | yes | yes
6030 Arguments : none
6031
6032 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006033 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006034 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6035 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6036 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6037 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6038
6039 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6040
6041 Example :
6042 option splice-response
6043
6044 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6045 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6046
6047 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6048 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6049
6050
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006051option srvtcpka
6052no option srvtcpka
6053 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6055 yes | no | yes | yes
6056 Arguments : none
6057
6058 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6059 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6060 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6061 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6062
6063 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6064 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6065 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6066 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6067
6068 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6069 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6070 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6071 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6072 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6073
6074 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6075
6076 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6077 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6078 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6079
6080 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6081 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6082
6083 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6084
6085
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006086option ssl-hello-chk
6087 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6089 yes | no | yes | yes
6090 Arguments : none
6091
6092 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6093 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6094 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6095 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6096 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6097 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6098 hello message.
6099
6100 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6101 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6102 messages, which is appreciable.
6103
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006104 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6105 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6106 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006107
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006108 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6109
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006110
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006111option tcp-check
6112 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6113 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6114 yes | no | yes | yes
6115
6116 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6117 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6118
6119 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6120 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6121 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6122
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006123 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006124 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6125 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6126 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6127 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6128 only.
6129
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006130 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006131 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6132 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6133 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6134 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6135
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006136 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006137 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6138 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006139 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006140 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6141 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6142 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6143 the respective protocols.
6144 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6145 analysed.
6146
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006147 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6148 script.
6149
6150 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6151 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6152 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6153 The "comment" is of course optional.
6154
6155
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006156 Examples :
6157 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6158 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006159 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006160
6161 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6162 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006163 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006164
6165 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6166 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006167 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006168 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006169 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006170 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006171 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006172 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006173 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6174 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006175 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006176 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6177 tcp-check expect string +OK
6178
6179 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6180 (send many headers before analyzing)
6181 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006182 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006183 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6184 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6185 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6186 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006187 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006188
6189
6190 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6191
6192
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006193option tcp-smart-accept
6194no option tcp-smart-accept
6195 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6197 yes | yes | yes | no
6198 Arguments : none
6199
6200 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6201 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6202 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6203 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6204 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6205 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6206
6207 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6208 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6209 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6210 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6211
6212 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6213 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6214 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6215 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6216
6217 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6218 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6219 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6220
6221 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6222 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6223 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6224
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006225 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6226
6227
6228option tcp-smart-connect
6229no option tcp-smart-connect
6230 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6232 yes | no | yes | yes
6233 Arguments : none
6234
6235 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6236 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6237 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6238 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6239 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6240
6241 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6242 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6243 complex.
6244
6245 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6246 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6247 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6248
6249 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6250 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6251
6252 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6253
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006254
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006255option tcpka
6256 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6258 yes | yes | yes | yes
6259 Arguments : none
6260
6261 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6262 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6263 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6264 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6265
6266 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6267 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6268 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6269 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6270
6271 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6272 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6273 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6274 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6275 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6276
6277 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6278
6279 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6280 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6281 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6282 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6283 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6284 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6285 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6286 backends.
6287
6288 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6289
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006290
6291option tcplog
6292 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6294 yes | yes | yes | yes
6295 Arguments : none
6296
6297 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6298 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6299 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6300 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6301 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6302 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6303 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6304 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6305
6306 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6307
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006308 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006309
6310
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006311option transparent
6312no option transparent
6313 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006315 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006316 Arguments : none
6317
6318 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6319 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6320 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6321 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6322 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6323 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6324 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6325 appropriate server.
6326
6327 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6328 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6329
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006330 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006331 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006332
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006333
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006334external-check command <command>
6335 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6337 yes | no | yes | yes
6338
6339 Arguments :
6340 <command> is the external command to run
6341
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006342 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6343
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006344 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006345
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006346 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6347 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6348 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6349 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6350 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6351 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006352
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006353 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6354
6355 Environment variables :
6356 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6357 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6358
6359 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6360
6361 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6362
6363 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6364 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6365 for a UNIX socket).
6366
6367 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6368
6369 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6370
6371 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6372
6373 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6374
6375 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6376
6377 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6378 socket).
6379
6380 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6381 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6382
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006383 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6384 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6385 failed.
6386
6387 Example :
6388 external-check command /bin/true
6389
6390 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6391
6392
6393external-check path <path>
6394 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6396 yes | no | yes | yes
6397
6398 Arguments :
6399 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6400
6401 The default path is "".
6402
6403 Example :
6404 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6405
6406 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6407 "external-check command"
6408
6409
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006410persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006411persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006412 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6414 yes | no | yes | yes
6415 Arguments :
6416 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006417 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6418 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006419
6420 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6421 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6422 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6423 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6424 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6425 forwarded to this server.
6426
6427 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6428 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6429 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006430 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006431 a single "listen" section.
6432
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006433 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6434 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6435 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6436
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006437 Example :
6438 listen tse-farm
6439 bind :3389
6440 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6441 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6442 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6443 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6444 persist rdp-cookie
6445 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006446 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006447 balance rdp-cookie
6448 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6449 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6450
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006451 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6452 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006453
6454
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006455rate-limit sessions <rate>
6456 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6458 yes | yes | yes | no
6459 Arguments :
6460 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6461 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6462
6463 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6464 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6465 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6466 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6467 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6468 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6469
6470 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6471 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6472 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6473 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6474
6475 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6476 listen smtp
6477 mode tcp
6478 bind :25
6479 rate-limit sessions 10
6480 server 127.0.0.1:1025
6481
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006482 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6483 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6484 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006485
6486 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6487
6488
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006489redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6490redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6491redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006492 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6494 no | yes | yes | yes
6495
6496 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006497 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006498
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006499 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006500 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006501 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6502 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6503 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006504
6505 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6506 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6507 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6508 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6509 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006510 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6511 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6512 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6513 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006514
6515 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6516 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6517 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6518 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6519 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6520 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006521 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006522 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006523 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6524 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6525 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006526
6527 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006528 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6529 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6530 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006531 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006532 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6533 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6534 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6535 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006536
6537 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6538 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6539
6540 - "drop-query"
6541 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6542 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6543 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6544 with a location-type redirect.
6545
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006546 - "append-slash"
6547 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6548 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6549 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6550 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6551
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006552 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6553 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6554 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6555 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6556 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6557 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6558 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6559
6560 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6561 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6562 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6563 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6564 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6565 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6566 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006567
6568 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6569 acl clear dst_port 80
6570 acl secure dst_port 8080
6571 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006572 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006573 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006574 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6575
6576 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006577 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6578 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6579 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006580 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006581
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006582 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6583 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6584 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6585
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006586 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006587 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006588
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006589 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
6590 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
6591 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
6592
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006593 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006594
6595
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006596redisp (deprecated)
6597redispatch (deprecated)
6598 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6599 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6600 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006601 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006602
6603 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6604 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6605 be able to access the service anymore.
6606
6607 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6608 redistribute them to a working server.
6609
6610 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6611 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6612 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006613
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006614 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6615 "option redispatch" instead.
6616
6617 See also : "option redispatch"
6618
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006619
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006620reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006621 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6623 no | yes | yes | yes
6624 Arguments :
6625 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6626 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006627 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006628
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006629 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6630 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6631
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006632 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6633 the last header of an HTTP request.
6634
6635 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6636 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6637 responses.
6638
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006639 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6640 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6641 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6642
6643 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6644 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006645
6646
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006647reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6648reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006649 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6651 no | yes | yes | yes
6652 Arguments :
6653 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6654 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6655 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6656 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6657 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6658 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6659 ignores case.
6660
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006661 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6662 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6663
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006664 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6665 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6666 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6667 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006668 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006669
6670 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6671 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6672
6673 Example :
6674 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6675 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6676 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6677
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006678 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
6679 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006680
6681
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006682reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6683reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006684 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6686 no | yes | yes | yes
6687 Arguments :
6688 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6689 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6690 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6691 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6692 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6693 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6694
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006695 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6696 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6697
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006698 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6699 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6700 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6701 next servers.
6702
6703 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6704 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6705 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6706
6707 Example :
6708 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
6709 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
6710 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
6711
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006712 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6713 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006714
6715
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006716reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6717reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006718 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6720 no | yes | yes | yes
6721 Arguments :
6722 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6723 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6724 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6725 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6726 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6727 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6728 case.
6729
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006730 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6731 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6732
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006733 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6734 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6735 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6736 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006737 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006738
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006739 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006740 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006741 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006742
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006743 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6744 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6745
6746 Example :
6747 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6748 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6749 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6750
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006751 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6752 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006753
6754
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006755reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6756reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006757 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6759 no | yes | yes | yes
6760 Arguments :
6761 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6762 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6763 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6764 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6765 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6766 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6767 case.
6768
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006769 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6770 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6771
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006772 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6773 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6774 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6775 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6776
6777 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6778 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6779
6780 Example :
6781 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6782 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6783 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6784 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6785
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006786 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6787 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006788
6789
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006790reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6791reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006792 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6794 no | yes | yes | yes
6795 Arguments :
6796 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6797 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6798 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6799 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6800 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6801 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6802
6803 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6804 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6805 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6806 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006807 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006808
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006809 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6810 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6811
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006812 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6813 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6814 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6815
6816 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6817 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6818 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6819 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6820 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6821
6822 Example :
6823 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006824 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006825 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6826 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6827
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04006828 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
6829 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006830
6831
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006832reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6833reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006834 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6836 no | yes | yes | yes
6837 Arguments :
6838 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6839 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6840 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6841 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6842 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6843 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
6844 ignores case.
6845
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006846 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6847 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6848
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006849 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6850 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006851 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
6852 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
6853 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006854 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
6855 not set.
6856
6857 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
6858 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
6859 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
6860 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
6861 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
6862
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006863 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006864 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
6865 # block all others.
6866 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
6867 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
6868
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006869 # block bad guys
6870 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
6871 reqitarpit . if badguys
6872
6873 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
6874 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006875
6876
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006877retries <value>
6878 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
6879 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6880 yes | no | yes | yes
6881 Arguments :
6882 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
6883 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
6884 default value is 3.
6885
6886 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
6887 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
6888 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
6889
6890 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006891 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
6892 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006893
6894 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
6895 server even if a cookie references a different server.
6896
6897 See also : "option redispatch"
6898
6899
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006900rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006901 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
6902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6903 no | yes | yes | yes
6904 Arguments :
6905 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6906 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006907 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006908
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006909 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6910 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6911
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006912 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6913 the last header of an HTTP response.
6914
6915 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6916 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6917 responses.
6918
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006919 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6920 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006921
6922
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006923rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6924rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006925 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
6926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6927 no | yes | yes | yes
6928 Arguments :
6929 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6930 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6931 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6932 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6933 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6934 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
6935 ignores case.
6936
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006937 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6938 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6939
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006940 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
6941 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006942 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006943 client.
6944
6945 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6946 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6947 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6948
6949 Example :
6950 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02006951 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006952
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006953 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6954 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006955
6956
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006957rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6958rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006959 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
6960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6961 no | yes | yes | yes
6962 Arguments :
6963 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6964 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6965 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6966 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6967 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6968 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
6969 ignores case.
6970
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006971 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6972 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6973
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006974 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6975 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
6976 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
6977 case-sensitive.
6978
6979 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006980 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
6981 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
6982 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006983
6984 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6985 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
6986
6987 Example :
6988 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
6989 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
6990
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006991 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
6992 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006993
6994
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006995rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6996rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006997 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
6998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6999 no | yes | yes | yes
7000 Arguments :
7001 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7002 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7003 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7004 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7005 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7006 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7007 ignores case.
7008
7009 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7010 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7011 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7012 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007013 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007014
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007015 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7016 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7017
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007018 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7019 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7020 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7021
7022 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7023 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7024 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7025 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7026 are not case-sensitive.
7027
7028 Example :
7029 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7030 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7031
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007032 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
7033 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007034
7035
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007036server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007037 Declare a server in a backend
7038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7039 no | no | yes | yes
7040 Arguments :
7041 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007042 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007043 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007044
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007045 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7046 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7047 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7048 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007049 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7050 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7051 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7052 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7053 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007054 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7055 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7056 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7057 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7058 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7059 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7060 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007061 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007062 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7063 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
7064 variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007065
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007066 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007067 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7068 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7069 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7070 adding this value to the client's port.
7071
7072 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7073 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007074 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007075
7076 Examples :
7077 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7078 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007079 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007080 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7081 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7082 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007083
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007084 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7085 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7086 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7087 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7088 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7089
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007090 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7091 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007092
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007093server-state-file-name [<file>]
7094 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7095 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7096 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7097 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7098 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7099 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7100
7101 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7102 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7103
7104 global
7105 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7106
7107 backend bk
7108 load-server-state-from-file
7109
7110 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7111 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007112
7113source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007114source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007115source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007116 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7118 yes | no | yes | yes
7119 Arguments :
7120 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7121 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007122
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007123 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007124 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7125 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7126 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7127 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7128 supported prefixes are :
7129 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7130 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7131 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007132 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007133 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7134 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007135
7136 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7137 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007138 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7139 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7140 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007141
7142 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7143 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7144 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7145 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7146 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7147 <addr>.
7148
7149 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7150 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7151 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7152 port.
7153
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007154 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7155 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7156 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7157 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007158 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007159 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7160 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7161 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7162 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7163 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7164 HTTP header.
7165
7166 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7167 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007168 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007169 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7170 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7171 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7172 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7173 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7174 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7175 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7176
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007177 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7178 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7179 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7180 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7181 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7182 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7183
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007184 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7185 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7186 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7187 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7188
7189 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7190 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7191 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7192 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7193 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7194 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7195
7196 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7197 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7198 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7199 there are two methods :
7200
7201 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7202 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7203 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7204 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7205 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7206 of the client ranges may be used.
7207
7208 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7209 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7210 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7211 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7212 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7213 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7214 same session.
7215
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007216 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7217 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7218 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007219 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007220
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007221 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7222
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007223 Examples :
7224 backend private
7225 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7226 source 192.168.1.200
7227
7228 backend transparent_ssl1
7229 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7230 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7231
7232 backend transparent_ssl2
7233 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7234 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7235 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7236
7237 backend transparent_ssl3
7238 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7239 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7240 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7241
7242 backend transparent_smtp
7243 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7244 # with Tproxy version 4.
7245 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7246
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007247 backend transparent_http
7248 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7249 # proxy.
7250 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007252 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007253 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7254
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007255
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007256srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7257 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7259 yes | no | yes | yes
7260 Arguments :
7261 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7262 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7263 as explained at the top of this document.
7264
7265 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7266 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7267 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7268 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7269 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7270 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7271 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7272
7273 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7274 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7275 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7276 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7277 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007278 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007279 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007280 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007281
7282 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7283 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7284 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7285 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7286 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7287 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7288
7289 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7290 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7291
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007292 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7293 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007294
7295
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007296stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7297 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007299 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007300
7301 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7302 matched.
7303
7304 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7305 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7306
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007307 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7308 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7309 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7310
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007311 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7312 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7313 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7314 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007315
7316 Example :
7317 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7318 backend stats_localhost
7319 stats enable
7320 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7321
7322 Example :
7323 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7324 backend stats_auth
7325 stats enable
7326 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7327 stats admin if TRUE
7328
7329 Example :
7330 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7331 userlist stats-auth
7332 group admin users admin
7333 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7334 group readonly users haproxy
7335 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7336
7337 backend stats_auth
7338 stats enable
7339 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7340 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7341 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7342 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7343
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007344 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7345 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7346 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007347
7348
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007349stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7350 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007352 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007353 Arguments :
7354 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7355
7356 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7357
7358 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7359 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7360 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7361 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7362 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7363 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7364
7365 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7366 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7367 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007368 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007369
7370 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7371 report using "stats scope".
7372
7373 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7374 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7375 unobvious parameters.
7376
7377 Example :
7378 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7379 backend public_www
7380 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7381 stats enable
7382 stats hide-version
7383 stats scope .
7384 stats uri /admin?stats
7385 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7386 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7387 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7388
7389 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7390 backend private_monitoring
7391 stats enable
7392 stats uri /admin?stats
7393 stats refresh 5s
7394
7395 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7396
7397
7398stats enable
7399 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007401 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007402 Arguments : none
7403
7404 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7405 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7406 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7407 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7408 - stats auth : no authentication
7409 - stats scope : no restriction
7410
7411 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7412 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7413 unobvious parameters.
7414
7415 Example :
7416 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7417 backend public_www
7418 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7419 stats enable
7420 stats hide-version
7421 stats scope .
7422 stats uri /admin?stats
7423 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7424 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7425 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7426
7427 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7428 backend private_monitoring
7429 stats enable
7430 stats uri /admin?stats
7431 stats refresh 5s
7432
7433 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7434
7435
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007436stats hide-version
7437 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007439 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007440 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007441
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007442 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7443 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7444 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7445 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7446 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7447 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007448
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007449 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7450 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7451 unobvious parameters.
7452
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007453 Example :
7454 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7455 backend public_www
7456 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007457 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007458 stats hide-version
7459 stats scope .
7460 stats uri /admin?stats
7461 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7462 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7463 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007464
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007465 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7466 backend private_monitoring
7467 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007468 stats uri /admin?stats
7469 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007470
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007471 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007472
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007473
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007474stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7475 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7476 Access control for statistics
7477
7478 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7479 no | no | yes | yes
7480
7481 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7482 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7483 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7484 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7485 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7486 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7487
7488 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7489 instance.
7490
7491 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7492 about ACL usage.
7493
7494
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007495stats realm <realm>
7496 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007498 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007499 Arguments :
7500 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7501 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7502 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7503
7504 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7505 using a backslash ('\').
7506
7507 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7508 only related to authentication.
7509
7510 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7511 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7512 unobvious parameters.
7513
7514 Example :
7515 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7516 backend public_www
7517 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7518 stats enable
7519 stats hide-version
7520 stats scope .
7521 stats uri /admin?stats
7522 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7523 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7524 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7525
7526 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7527 backend private_monitoring
7528 stats enable
7529 stats uri /admin?stats
7530 stats refresh 5s
7531
7532 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7533
7534
7535stats refresh <delay>
7536 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007538 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007539 Arguments :
7540 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7541 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7542 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7543 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7544 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7545 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7546
7547 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7548 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7549 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7550 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7551
7552 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7553 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7554 unobvious parameters.
7555
7556 Example :
7557 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7558 backend public_www
7559 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7560 stats enable
7561 stats hide-version
7562 stats scope .
7563 stats uri /admin?stats
7564 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7565 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7566 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7567
7568 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7569 backend private_monitoring
7570 stats enable
7571 stats uri /admin?stats
7572 stats refresh 5s
7573
7574 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7575
7576
7577stats scope { <name> | "." }
7578 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007580 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007581 Arguments :
7582 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7583 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7584 section in which the statement appears.
7585
7586 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7587 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7588 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7589 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7590 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7591 exists.
7592
7593 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7594 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7595 unobvious parameters.
7596
7597 Example :
7598 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7599 backend public_www
7600 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7601 stats enable
7602 stats hide-version
7603 stats scope .
7604 stats uri /admin?stats
7605 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7606 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7607 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7608
7609 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7610 backend private_monitoring
7611 stats enable
7612 stats uri /admin?stats
7613 stats refresh 5s
7614
7615 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7616
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007617
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007618stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007619 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007621 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007622
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007623 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007624 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7625
7626 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7627 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7628
7629 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7630 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007631 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007632
7633 Example :
7634 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7635 backend private_monitoring
7636 stats enable
7637 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7638 stats uri /admin?stats
7639 stats refresh 5s
7640
7641 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7642 global section.
7643
7644
7645stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007646 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7648 yes | yes | yes | yes
7649 Arguments : none
7650
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007651 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007652 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7653 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7654 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7655 - IP (socket, server)
7656 - cookie (backend, server)
7657
7658 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7659 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007660 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007661
7662 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7663
7664
7665stats show-node [ <name> ]
7666 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007668 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007669 Arguments:
7670 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7671 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7672
7673 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7674 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007675 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007676
7677 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7678 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7679 unobvious parameters.
7680
7681 Example:
7682 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7683 backend private_monitoring
7684 stats enable
7685 stats show-node Europe-1
7686 stats uri /admin?stats
7687 stats refresh 5s
7688
7689 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7690 section.
7691
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007692
7693stats uri <prefix>
7694 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007696 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007697 Arguments :
7698 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7699 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7700 query string.
7701
7702 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7703 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7704 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
7705 possible to reach it in the application.
7706
7707 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007708 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007709 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
7710 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
7711 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
7712 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
7713
7714 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
7715 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
7716 an address or a port to statistics only.
7717
7718 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7719 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7720 unobvious parameters.
7721
7722 Example :
7723 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7724 backend public_www
7725 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7726 stats enable
7727 stats hide-version
7728 stats scope .
7729 stats uri /admin?stats
7730 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7731 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7732 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7733
7734 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7735 backend private_monitoring
7736 stats enable
7737 stats uri /admin?stats
7738 stats refresh 5s
7739
7740 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7741
7742
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007743stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7744 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007746 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007747
7748 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007749 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007750 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7751 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7752 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7753
7754 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7755 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7756 the "stick-table" statement.
7757
7758 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7759 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7760 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7761 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7762 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7763
7764 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7765 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7766 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7767 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7768 transformation rules.
7769
7770 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7771 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7772 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7773 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7774 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7775 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7776 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7777
7778 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7779 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7780 ACL based conditions.
7781
7782 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7783 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7784 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7785 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7786
7787 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7788 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7789 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7790 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7791
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007792 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7793 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7794 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7795
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007796 Example :
7797 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7798 # last 30 minutes
7799 backend pop
7800 mode tcp
7801 balance roundrobin
7802 stick store-request src
7803 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7804 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7805 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7806
7807 backend smtp
7808 mode tcp
7809 balance roundrobin
7810 stick match src table pop
7811 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7812 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7813
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007814 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007815 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007816
7817
7818stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7819 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7821 no | no | yes | yes
7822
7823 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7824 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7825 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7826 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7827
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007828 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7829 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7830 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7831
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007832 Examples :
7833 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007834 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007835
7836 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7837 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7838 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
7839
7840
7841 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
7842 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
7843 backend http
7844 mode http
7845 balance roundrobin
7846 stick on src table https
7847 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
7848 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
7849 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
7850
7851 backend https
7852 mode tcp
7853 balance roundrobin
7854 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7855 stick on src
7856 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7857 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7858
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007859 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007860
7861
7862stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7863 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7865 no | no | yes | yes
7866
7867 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007868 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007869 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7870 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7871 server is selected.
7872
7873 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7874 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7875 the "stick-table" statement.
7876
7877 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7878 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7879 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
7880 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
7881 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
7882 address.
7883
7884 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7885 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
7886 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
7887 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
7888 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
7889 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
7890 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
7891 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
7892 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
7893 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
7894
7895 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7896 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7897 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7898 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7899 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7900 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7901 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7902
7903 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
7904 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7905 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
7906 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7907
7908 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
7909 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7910 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7911 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7912 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7913 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007914 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
7915 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7916 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7917 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7918 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7919 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007920
7921 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
7922 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
7923 the request.
7924
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007925 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7926 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7927 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7928
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007929 Example :
7930 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7931 # last 30 minutes
7932 backend pop
7933 mode tcp
7934 balance roundrobin
7935 stick store-request src
7936 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7937 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7938 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7939
7940 backend smtp
7941 mode tcp
7942 balance roundrobin
7943 stick match src table pop
7944 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7945 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7946
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007947 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007948 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007949
7950
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007951stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007952 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
7953 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08007954 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007956 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007957
7958 Arguments :
7959 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
7960 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
7961 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7962 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7963
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007964 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
7965 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
7966 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7967 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7968
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007969 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
7970 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
7971 instance.
7972
7973 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
7974 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
7975 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
7976 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
7977 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
7978 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007979 to 32 characters.
7980
7981 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
7982 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
7983 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007984 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007985 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
7986 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007987
7988 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007989 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
7990 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007991 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
7992 increase.
7993
7994 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007995 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
7996 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
7997 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007998
7999 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8000 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8001 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8002 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8003 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8004 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8005 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8006 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8007 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8008 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8009 parameter (see below).
8010
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008011 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8012 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8013 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8014 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8015 soft restart.
8016
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008017 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8018 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008019
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008020 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8021 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8022 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8023 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8024 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008025 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008026 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8027 if not expiration delay is specified.
8028
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008029 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8030 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8031 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8032 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008033 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8034 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8035 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8036 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8037 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8038 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8039 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8040 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8041 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8042 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8043 types and their arguments.
8044
8045 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8046 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8047 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8048 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8049
8050 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8051 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8052 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8053 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8054
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008055 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8056 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8057 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8058 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8059 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8060 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8061
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008062 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8063 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8064 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8065 they were received.
8066
8067 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8068 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8069 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8070 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8071 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8072
8073 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8074 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8075 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8076 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8077 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8078
8079 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8080 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8081 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8082
8083 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8084 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8085 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8086 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8087 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8088
8089 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8090 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8091 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8092 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8093 the client side.
8094
8095 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8096 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8097 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8098 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8099 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8100 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8101 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8102
8103 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8104 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8105 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8106 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8107 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8108 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8109 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8110
8111 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8112 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8113 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8114 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8115 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8116 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8117
8118 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8119 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8120 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8121 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8122
8123 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8124 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8125 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8126 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8127 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8128 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8129 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8130 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8131 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8132 recommended for better fairness.
8133
8134 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8135 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8136 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8137 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8138
8139 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8140 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8141 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8142 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8143 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8144 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8145 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8146 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8147 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8148 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008149
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008150 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8151 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008152 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8153 reference it.
8154
8155 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8156 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
8157 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
8158 as an exclusive stickiness.
8159
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008160 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8161 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8162 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8163 something that can be ignored.
8164
8165 Example:
8166 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8167 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8168 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8169 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8170
8171 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008172 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008173
8174
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008175stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8176 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8178 no | no | yes | yes
8179
8180 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008181 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008182 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8183 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8184 server is selected.
8185
8186 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8187 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8188 the "stick-table" statement.
8189
8190 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8191 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8192 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8193 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8194
8195 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8196 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8197 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8198 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8199 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8200 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008201 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008202 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8203 rules.
8204
8205 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8206 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8207 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8208 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8209 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8210 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8211 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8212
8213 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8214 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8215 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8216 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8217
8218 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8219 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8220 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8221 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8222 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8223 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008224 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8225 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8226 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8227 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8228 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8229 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8230 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8231 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8232 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008233
8234 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8235
8236 Example :
8237 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8238 backend https
8239 mode tcp
8240 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008241 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008242 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008243
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008244 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8245 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8246
8247 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8248 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8249 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8250
8251 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8252 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008253
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008254 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8255 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8256 # at offset 44.
8257
8258 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8259 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8260
8261 # Learn on response if server hello.
8262 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008263
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008264 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8265 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8266
8267 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8268 extraction.
8269
8270
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008271tcp-check connect [params*]
8272 Opens a new connection
8273 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8274 no | no | yes | yes
8275
8276 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8277 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8278 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8279
8280 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8281 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8282 of the sequence.
8283
8284 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8285 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8286 do.
8287
8288 Parameters :
8289 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8290 use the TCP connection.
8291
8292 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8293 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8294 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8295
8296 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8297
8298 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8299
8300 Examples:
8301 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8302 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8303 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8304 option tcp-check
8305 tcp-check connect
8306 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8307 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8308 tcp-check send \r\n
8309 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8310 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8311 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8312 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8313 tcp-check send \r\n
8314 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8315 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8316
8317 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8318 option tcp-check
8319 tcp-check connect port 110
8320 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8321 tcp-check connect port 143
8322 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8323 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8324
8325 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8326
8327
8328tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8329 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8330 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8331 no | no | yes | yes
8332
8333 Arguments :
8334 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8335 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8336 binary.
8337 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8338 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8339 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8340
8341 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8342 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8343 with the usual backslash ('\').
8344 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8345 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8346 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8347 used upper or lower case.
8348
8349
8350 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8351
8352 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8353 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8354 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8355 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8356 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8357 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8358 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8359 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8360
8361 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8362 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8363 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8364 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8365 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8366 expression.
8367
8368 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8369 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8370 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8371 this exact hexadecimal string.
8372 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8373
8374 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8375 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8376 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8377 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8378 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8379 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8380 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8381 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8382 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8383 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8384 the null character.
8385
8386 Examples :
8387 # perform a POP check
8388 option tcp-check
8389 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8390
8391 # perform an IMAP check
8392 option tcp-check
8393 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8394
8395 # look for the redis master server
8396 option tcp-check
8397 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008398 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008399 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8400 tcp-check expect string role:master
8401 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8402 tcp-check expect string +OK
8403
8404
8405 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8406 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8407
8408
8409tcp-check send <data>
8410 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8411 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8412 no | no | yes | yes
8413
8414 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8415 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8416
8417 Examples :
8418 # look for the redis master server
8419 option tcp-check
8420 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8421 tcp-check expect string role:master
8422
8423 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8424 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8425
8426
8427tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8428 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8429 tcp health check
8430 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8431 no | no | yes | yes
8432
8433 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8434 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8435 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8436 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8437 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8438 hexadecimal string.
8439 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8440
8441 Examples :
8442 # redis check in binary
8443 option tcp-check
8444 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8445 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8446
8447
8448 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8449 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8450
8451
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008452tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8453 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8455 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008456 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008457 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8458 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008459
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008460 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008461
8462 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8463 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008464 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8465 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8466 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8467 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8468 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8469 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008470
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008471 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8472 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8473 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8474 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008475
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008476 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008477 - accept :
8478 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8479 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8480 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008481
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008482 - reject :
8483 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8484 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8485 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8486 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8487 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8488 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8489 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8490 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8491 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8492 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8493 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
8494 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008495
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008496 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8497 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8498 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8499 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8500 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8501 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8502 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8503 hosts.
8504
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008505 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8506 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8507 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8508 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8509 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8510 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8511 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8512 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8513 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008514 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8515 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008516
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008517 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008518 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008519 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008520 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008521 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8522 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008523 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008524 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8525 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8526 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8527 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8528 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008529
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008530 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008531 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008532 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008533 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8534 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8535 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8536 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008537
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008538 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8539 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8540 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8541 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008542
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008543 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8544 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8545 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8546 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8547 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008548 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8549 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8550 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8551 layer7 information is extracted.
8552
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008553 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8554 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8555 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8556 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8557 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008558
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008559 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8560 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8561 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
8562 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
8563
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008564 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
8565 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8566 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8567 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8568 continues.
8569
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008570 - "silent-drop" :
8571 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
8572 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
8573 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
8574 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
8575 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
8576 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
8577 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
8578 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
8579 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
8580 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
8581 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
8582 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
8583 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
8584 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
8585 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
8586 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
8587
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008588 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8589 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8590 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008591
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008592 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
8593 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
8594 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008595
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008596 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008597 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008598 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008599
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008600 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
8601 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
8602 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008603
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008604 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008605 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8606 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008607
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008608 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
8609
8610 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
8611
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008612 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8613
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008614 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008615
8616
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008617tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8618 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008620 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008621 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008622 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8623 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008624
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008625 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008626
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008627 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
8628 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8629 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
8630 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
8631 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008632
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008633 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
8634 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
8635 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
8636 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008637 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
8638 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
8639 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
8640 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
8641 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
8642 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008643 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008644 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008645
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008646 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8647 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8648 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8649 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008650
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008651 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008652 - accept : the request is accepted
8653 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
8654 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008655 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008656 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008657 - set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008658 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008659 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008660
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008661 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
8662 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008663
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008664 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
8665 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
8666 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
8667 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
8668 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
8669 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008670
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008671 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008672 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8673 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008674
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008675 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008676 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
8677 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
8678 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
8679 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008680 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
8681 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
8682 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008683
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008684 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008685 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
8686 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
8687 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008688
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008689 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8690 declared inline.
8691
8692 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its scope.
8693 The allowed scopes are:
8694 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
8695 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
8696 (request and response)
8697 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
8698 processing
8699 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
8700 processing.
8701 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
8702 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
8703
8704 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8705 followed by some converters.
8706
8707 Example:
8708
8709 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8710
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008711 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008712 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
8713 # and reject everything else.
8714 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
8715 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008716 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008717 tcp-request content reject
8718
8719 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008720 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
8721 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8722 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008723 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008724
8725 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
8726 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8727 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008728 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008729 tcp-request content reject
8730
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008731 Example:
8732 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
8733 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008734 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008735
8736 Example:
8737 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
8738 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008739 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008740
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008741 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
8742 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
8743
8744 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008745 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008746 # protecting all our sites
8747 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008748 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8749 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008750 ...
8751 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
8752
8753 backend http_dynamic
8754 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008755 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008756 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008757 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8758 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
8759 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008760 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008761
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008762 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008763
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008764 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008765
8766
8767tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
8768 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
8769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008770 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008771 Arguments :
8772 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8773 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8774 as explained at the top of this document.
8775
8776 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
8777 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
8778 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
8779 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
8780 data for at most the specified amount of time.
8781
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008782 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
8783 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
8784 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
8785 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
8786
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008787 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
8788 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008789 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008790 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01008791 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
8792 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
8793 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
8794 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008795
8796 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
8797 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
8798 it pass through unaffected.
8799
8800 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
8801 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
8802 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008803 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008804 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
8805 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02008806 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
8807 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
8808 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008809
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008810 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008811 "timeout client".
8812
8813
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008814tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8815 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
8816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8817 no | no | yes | yes
8818 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008819 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8820 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008821
8822 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
8823
8824 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
8825 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8826 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008827 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
8828 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008829
8830 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
8831
8832 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8833 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8834 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8835 inserted.
8836
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008837 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008838 - accept :
8839 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8840 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8841 the rules evaluation.
8842
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008843 - close :
8844 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
8845 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
8846 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
8847 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
8848 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
8849 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008850 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008851 protocols.
8852
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008853 - reject :
8854 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8855 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008856 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008857
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008858 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
8859 Sets a variable.
8860
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008861 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8862 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8863 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
8864 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
8865
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008866 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
8867 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8868 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8869 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8870 continues.
8871
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008872 - "silent-drop" :
8873 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
8874 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
8875 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
8876 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
8877 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
8878 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
8879 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
8880 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
8881 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
8882 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
8883 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
8884 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
8885 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
8886 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
8887 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
8888 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
8889
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008890 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8891 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8892 for changing the default action to a reject.
8893
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008894 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
8895 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
8896 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
8897 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008898 period.
8899
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008900 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8901 declared inline.
8902
8903 <var-name> The name of the variable starts by an indication about its scope.
8904 The allowed scopes are:
8905 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
8906 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction
8907 (request and response)
8908 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request
8909 processing
8910 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response
8911 processing.
8912 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
8913 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
8914
8915 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8916 followed by some converters.
8917
8918 Example:
8919
8920 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8921
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008922 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8923
8924 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
8925
8926
8927tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
8928 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
8929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8930 no | no | yes | yes
8931 Arguments :
8932 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8933 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8934 as explained at the top of this document.
8935
8936 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
8937
8938
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008939timeout check <timeout>
8940 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
8941 established.
8942
8943 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8944 yes | no | yes | yes
8945 Arguments:
8946 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8947 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8948 as explained at the top of this document.
8949
8950 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
8951 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
8952 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
8953 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01008954 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
8955 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
8956 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008957
8958 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
8959 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
8960
8961 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
8962 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008963 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008964
8965 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8966 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8967 forget about it.
8968
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008969 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
8970 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008971
8972
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008973timeout client <timeout>
8974timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8975 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
8976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8977 yes | yes | yes | no
8978 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008979 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008980 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8981 as explained at the top of this document.
8982
8983 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8984 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8985 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
8986 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
8987 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
8988 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
8989 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
8990 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008991 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008992 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008993 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
8994 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008995 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
8996 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008997
8998 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8999 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9000 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9001 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9002 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9003 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9004
9005 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9006 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9007 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9008
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009009 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009010
9011
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009012timeout client-fin <timeout>
9013 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9015 yes | yes | yes | no
9016 Arguments :
9017 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9018 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9019 as explained at the top of this document.
9020
9021 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9022 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9023 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9024 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9025 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9026 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9027 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9028 down in one direction.
9029
9030 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9031 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9032 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9033
9034 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9035
9036
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009037timeout connect <timeout>
9038timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9039 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9041 yes | no | yes | yes
9042 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009043 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009044 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9045 as explained at the top of this document.
9046
9047 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009048 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009049 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009050 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009051 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9052 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009053
9054 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9055 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9056 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9057 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9058 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9059 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9060
9061 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9062 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9063 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9064
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009065 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9066 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009067
9068
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009069timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9070 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9072 yes | yes | yes | yes
9073 Arguments :
9074 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9075 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9076 as explained at the top of this document.
9077
9078 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9079 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9080 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9081 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9082 once the request has started to present itself.
9083
9084 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9085 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9086 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9087 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9088 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9089
9090 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9091 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9092 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9093 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9094
9095 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9096 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9097 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9098 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9099 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009100 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009101
9102 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9103 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9104 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9105 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9106
9107 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9108
9109
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009110timeout http-request <timeout>
9111 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009113 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009114 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009115 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009116 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9117 as explained at the top of this document.
9118
9119 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9120 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9121 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9122 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9123 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9124 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9125 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009126 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9127 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9128 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9129 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9130 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009131 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9132 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009133
9134 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
9135 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009136 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
9137 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009138
9139 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9140 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9141 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9142 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9143 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9144
9145 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009146 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9147 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9148 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009149
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009150 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
9151 "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009152
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009153
9154timeout queue <timeout>
9155 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9157 yes | no | yes | yes
9158 Arguments :
9159 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9160 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9161 as explained at the top of this document.
9162
9163 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9164 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9165 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9166 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9167 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9168
9169 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9170 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9171 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9172 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9173
9174 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9175
9176
9177timeout server <timeout>
9178timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9179 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9181 yes | no | yes | yes
9182 Arguments :
9183 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9184 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9185 as explained at the top of this document.
9186
9187 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9188 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9189 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9190 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9191 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9192 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9193 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9194
9195 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9196 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9197 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9198 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9199 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009200 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009201 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009202 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9203 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9204 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9205 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009206
9207 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9208 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9209 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9210 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9211 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9212 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9213
9214 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9215 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9216 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9217
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009218 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009219
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009220
9221timeout server-fin <timeout>
9222 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9224 yes | no | yes | yes
9225 Arguments :
9226 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9227 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9228 as explained at the top of this document.
9229
9230 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9231 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9232 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9233 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9234 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9235 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9236 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9237 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9238 situations, it should not be needed.
9239
9240 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9241 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9242 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9243
9244 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9245
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009246
9247timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009248 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9250 yes | yes | yes | yes
9251 Arguments :
9252 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9253 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9254 as explained at the top of this document.
9255
9256 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
9257 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
9258 defines how long it will be maintained open.
9259
9260 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9261 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9262 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9263 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009264 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009265
9266 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9267
9268
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009269timeout tunnel <timeout>
9270 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9272 yes | no | yes | yes
9273 Arguments :
9274 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9275 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9276 as explained at the top of this document.
9277
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009278 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009279 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9280 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9281 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9282 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9283 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9284 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9285 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9286 specified.
9287
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009288 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9289 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9290 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9291 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9292 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9293 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9294 state.
9295
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009296 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9297 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9298 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9299 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9300 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9301
9302 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9303 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9304 forget about it.
9305
9306 Example :
9307 defaults http
9308 option http-server-close
9309 timeout connect 5s
9310 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009311 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009312 timeout server 30s
9313 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9314
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009315 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009316
9317
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009318transparent (deprecated)
9319 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009321 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009322 Arguments : none
9323
9324 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9325 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9326 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9327 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9328 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9329 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9330 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9331 appropriate server.
9332
9333 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9334
9335 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9336 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9337
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009338 See also: "option transparent"
9339
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009340unique-id-format <string>
9341 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9343 yes | yes | yes | no
9344 Arguments :
9345 <string> is a log-format string.
9346
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009347 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9348 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9349 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9350 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009351
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009352 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9353 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9354 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9355 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9356 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9357 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
9358 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
9359 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009360
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009361 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
9362 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009363
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009364 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009365
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009366 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009367
9368 will generate:
9369
9370 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9371
9372 See also: "unique-id-header"
9373
9374unique-id-header <name>
9375 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
9376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9377 yes | yes | yes | no
9378 Arguments :
9379 <name> is the name of the header.
9380
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009381 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
9382 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009383
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009384 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009385
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009386 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009387 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9388
9389 will generate:
9390
9391 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9392
9393 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009394
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009395use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009396 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9398 no | yes | yes | no
9399 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009400 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9401 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009402
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009403 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9404 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009405
9406 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9407 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9408 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009409 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9410 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9411 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9412 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009413
9414 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9415 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9416 assign the backend.
9417
9418 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
9419 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9420 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
9421 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
9422 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
9423 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
9424
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009425 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009426 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009427 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
9428 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
9429 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
9430
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009431 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
9432 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
9433 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
9434 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
9435 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
9436 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
9437 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
9438 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
9439 cannot be forced from the request.
9440
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009441 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009442 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
9443 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
9444
9445 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
9446 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009447
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009448
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009449use-server <server> if <condition>
9450use-server <server> unless <condition>
9451 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
9452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9453 no | no | yes | yes
9454 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009455 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009456
9457 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
9458
9459 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
9460 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
9461 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
9462
9463 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
9464 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
9465 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
9466 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
9467 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
9468 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
9469 matches will assign the server.
9470
9471 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
9472 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
9473 with the next rules until one matches.
9474
9475 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
9476 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9477 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
9478 according to other persistence mechanisms.
9479
9480 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
9481 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
9482 stripped.
9483
9484 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
9485 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
9486 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
9487 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
9488
9489 Example :
9490 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
9491 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
9492 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
9493 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
9494 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
9495 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
9496 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
9497 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
9498 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
9499
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009500 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009501
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009502
95035. Bind and Server options
9504--------------------------
9505
9506The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
9507depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
9508settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
9509written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
9510described in this section.
9511
9512
95135.1. Bind options
9514-----------------
9515
9516The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
9517as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
9518no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
9519parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
9520while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
9521provided immediately after the setting name.
9522
9523The currently supported settings are the following ones.
9524
9525accept-proxy
9526 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02009527 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
9528 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009529 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
9530 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
9531 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
9532 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
9533 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
9534 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
9535 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009536 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
9537 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009538
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009539alpn <protocols>
9540 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
9541 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
9542 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
9543 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
9544 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
9545 initial NPN extension.
9546
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009547backlog <backlog>
9548 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
9549 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
9550
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009551ecdhe <named curve>
9552 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01009553 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
9554 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009555
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009556ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009557 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9558 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9559 client's certificate.
9560
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009561ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
9562 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9563 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
9564 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
9565 error is ignored.
9566
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009567ca-sign-file <cafile>
9568 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9569 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
9570 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
9571 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9572 'generate-certificates' for details.
9573
9574ca-sign-passphrase <passphrase>
9575 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
9576 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
9577 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9578 'generate-certificates' for details.
9579
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009580ciphers <ciphers>
9581 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
9582 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009583 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009584 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
9585 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
9586
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009587crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009588 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9589 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9590 to verify client's certificate.
9591
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009592crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009593 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9594 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
9595 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
9596 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
9597 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
9598 file.
9599
9600 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
9601 are loaded.
9602
9603 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009604 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009605 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
9606 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
9607 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
9608 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
9609 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
9610 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
9611 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009612
9613 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
9614 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
9615 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
9616 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009617 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
9618 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009619
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02009620 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009621
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009622 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
9623 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08009624 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009625 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
9626 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
9627 clients).
9628
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02009629 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
9630 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
9631 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
9632 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
9633 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
9634 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
9635 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
9636 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
9637 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
9638 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
9639 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
9640 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
9641 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
9642
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009643 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
9644 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
9645 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
9646 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
9647 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
9648
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009649crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009650 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
9651 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009652 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009653 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009654
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009655crt-list <file>
9656 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009657 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
9658 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009659
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009660 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009661
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009662 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
9663 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
9664 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
9665 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
9666 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
9667 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
9668 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
9669 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009670
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009671defer-accept
9672 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9673 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
9674 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
9675 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
9676 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
9677 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
9678 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
9679 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
9680 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
9681 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
9682 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
9683
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009684force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009685 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009686 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009687 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9688 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009689
9690force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009691 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009692 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9693 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009694
9695force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009696 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009697 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9698 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009699
9700force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009701 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009702 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9703 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009704
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009705generate-certificates
9706 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9707 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
9708 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
9709 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
9710 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
9711 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
9712 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
9713 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
9714 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
9715 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
9716 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
9717
9718 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
9719 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
9720 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
9721 certificate is used many times.
9722
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009723gid <gid>
9724 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
9725 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9726 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
9727 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
9728 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9729
9730group <group>
9731 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
9732 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
9733 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
9734 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
9735 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9736
9737id <id>
9738 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
9739 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
9740 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
9741 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
9742
9743interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01009744 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
9745 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
9746 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
9747 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
9748 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
9749 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
9750 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009751
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02009752level <level>
9753 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
9754 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
9755 sockets. <level> can be one of :
9756 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
9757 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
9758 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
9759 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
9760 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
9761 counters).
9762 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
9763 all counters).
9764
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009765maxconn <maxconn>
9766 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
9767 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
9768 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
9769 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
9770 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
9771 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
9772 eat all memory.
9773
9774mode <mode>
9775 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
9776 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
9777 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
9778 UNIX sockets.
9779
9780mss <maxseg>
9781 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
9782 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
9783 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
9784 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
9785 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
9786 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
9787 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
9788 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
9789 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
9790 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
9791 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
9792
9793name <name>
9794 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
9795 page.
9796
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +02009797namespace <name>
9798 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
9799 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
9800 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
9801 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
9802
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009803nice <nice>
9804 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
9805 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
9806 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
9807 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
9808 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
9809 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
9810 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
9811 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
9812 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
9813 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
9814 one for an RDP socket.
9815
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009816no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009817 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009818 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009819 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009820 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
9821 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009822 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009823
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009824no-tls-tickets
9825 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9826 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9827 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009828 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
9829 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009830
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009831no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009832 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009833 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009834 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009835 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9836 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9837 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009838
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009839no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009840 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009841 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009842 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009843 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9844 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9845 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009846
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009847no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009848 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009849 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009850 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009851 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
9852 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
9853 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009854
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009855npn <protocols>
9856 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
9857 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
9858 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
9859 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009860 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
9861 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02009862
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009863process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
9864 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
9865 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
9866 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
9867 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
9868 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
9869 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
9870 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02009871 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
9872 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
9873 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
9874 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
9875 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
9876 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
9877 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02009878
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009879ssl
9880 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009881 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009882 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
9883 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
9884 to deciphered contents.
9885
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01009886strict-sni
9887 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
9888 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
9889 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
9890 See the "crt" option for more information.
9891
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +01009892tcp-ut <delay>
9893 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
9894 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
9895 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
9896 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
9897 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
9898 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
9899 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
9900 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
9901 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
9902 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
9903 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
9904
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009905tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01009906 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009907 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
9908 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
9909 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
9910 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
9911 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
9912 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
9913 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02009914 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
9915 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
9916 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009917
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +01009918tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
9919 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
9920 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
9921 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
9922 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
9923 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
9924 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
9925 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
9926 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
9927 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
9928 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
9929
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009930transparent
9931 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9932 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
9933 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
9934 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
9935 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
9936 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
9937 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
9938 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
9939 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
9940 so check for support with your vendor.
9941
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009942v4v6
9943 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9944 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
9945 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
9946 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009947 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009948
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009949v6only
9950 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9951 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
9952 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009953 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
9954 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009955
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009956uid <uid>
9957 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
9958 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9959 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
9960 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
9961 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9962
9963user <user>
9964 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
9965 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9966 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
9967 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
9968 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9969
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009970verify [none|optional|required]
9971 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
9972 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
9973 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
9974 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
9975 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009976 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
9977 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
9978 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
9979 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009980
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020099815.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009982------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009983
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009984The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
9985which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
9986arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
9987settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
9988after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
9989Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
9990address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009991
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009992 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009993 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009994
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009995The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009996
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009997addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009998 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
9999 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
10000 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
10001 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
10002 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010003
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010004 Supported in default-server: No
10005
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010006agent-check
10007 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010008 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10009 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10010 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10011 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010012
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010013 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010014 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010015 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10016 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10017 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010018
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010019 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10020 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010021
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010022 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10023 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10024 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010025
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010026 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10027 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10028 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010029
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010030 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10031 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10032 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10033 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10034 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10035 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10036 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010037
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010038 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10039 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010040
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010041 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10042 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10043 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10044 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10045 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10046 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10047 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10048 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10049 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010050
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010051 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10052 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010053 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10054 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10055 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
10056 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010057
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010058 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
10059 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010060
10061 Supported in default-server: No
10062
10063agent-inter <delay>
10064 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10065 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10066
10067 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10068 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10069 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10070 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10071 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10072 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10073 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10074 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10075 of backends use the same servers.
10076
10077 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10078
10079 Supported in default-server: Yes
10080
10081agent-port <port>
10082 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10083
10084 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10085
10086 Supported in default-server: Yes
10087
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010088backup
10089 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10090 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10091 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10092 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
10093 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
10094 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010095
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010096 Supported in default-server: No
10097
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010098ca-file <cafile>
10099 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10100 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10101 server's certificate.
10102
10103 Supported in default-server: No
10104
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010105check
10106 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010107 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10108 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10109 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10110 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10111 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10112 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10113 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010114 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10115 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
10116 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010117
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010118 Supported in default-server: No
10119
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010120check-send-proxy
10121 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10122 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10123 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10124 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10125 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10126 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10127 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10128
10129 Supported in default-server: No
10130
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010131check-ssl
10132 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10133 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10134 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10135 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010136 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010137 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10138 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10139 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
10140 See the "ssl" option for more information.
10141
10142 Supported in default-server: No
10143
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010144ciphers <ciphers>
10145 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010146 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010147 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10148 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10149 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10150 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10151 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10152 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10153
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010154 Supported in default-server: No
10155
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010156cookie <value>
10157 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10158 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10159 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10160 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10161 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10162 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10163 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10164
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010165 Supported in default-server: No
10166
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010167crl-file <crlfile>
10168 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10169 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10170 to verify server's certificate.
10171
10172 Supported in default-server: No
10173
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010174crt <cert>
10175 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10176 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10177 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10178 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10179 certificate request.
10180
10181 Supported in default-server: No
10182
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010183disabled
10184 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10185 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10186 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10187 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10188 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
10189
10190 Supported in default-server: No
10191
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010192error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010193 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10194 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10195 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010196
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010197 Supported in default-server: Yes
10198
10199 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010200
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010201fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010202 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
10203 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
10204 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
10205
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010206 Supported in default-server: Yes
10207
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010208force-sslv3
10209 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10210 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010211 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10212 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010213
10214 Supported in default-server: No
10215
10216force-tlsv10
10217 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010218 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10219 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010220
10221 Supported in default-server: No
10222
10223force-tlsv11
10224 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010225 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10226 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010227
10228 Supported in default-server: No
10229
10230force-tlsv12
10231 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010232 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10233 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010234
10235 Supported in default-server: No
10236
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010237id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020010238 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
10239 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
10240 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010241
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010242 Supported in default-server: No
10243
10244inter <delay>
10245fastinter <delay>
10246downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010247 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
10248 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10249 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
10250 between checks depending on the server state :
10251
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020010252 Server state | Interval used
10253 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10254 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
10255 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10256 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
10257 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
10258 or yet unchecked. |
10259 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10260 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
10261 | "inter" otherwise.
10262 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010263
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010264 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
10265 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
10266 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
10267 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010268 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10269 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10270 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10271 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10272 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010273
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010274 Supported in default-server: Yes
10275
10276maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010277 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
10278 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
10279 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
10280 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
10281 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
10282 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
10283 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
10284 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
10285
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010286 Supported in default-server: Yes
10287
10288maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010289 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
10290 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
10291 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
10292 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
10293 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
10294 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
10295 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
10296
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010297 Supported in default-server: Yes
10298
10299minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010300 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
10301 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
10302 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
10303 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
10304 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
10305 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010306 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010307 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010308
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010309 Supported in default-server: Yes
10310
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010311namespace <name>
10312 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10313 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
10314 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10315 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10316
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010010317no-ssl-reuse
10318 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
10319 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
10320 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
10321 and for paranoid users.
10322
10323 Supported in default-server: No
10324
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010325no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010326 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
10327 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010328 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010329
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010330 Supported in default-server: No
10331
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010332no-tls-tickets
10333 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10334 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10335 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010336 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
10337 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010338
10339 Supported in default-server: No
10340
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010341no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010342 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010343 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10344 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010345 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10346 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10347 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010348
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010349 Supported in default-server: No
10350
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010351no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010352 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010353 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10354 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010355 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10356 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10357 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010358
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010359 Supported in default-server: No
10360
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010361no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010362 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010363 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10364 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010365 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10366 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10367 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010368
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010369 Supported in default-server: No
10370
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090010371non-stick
10372 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
10373 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
10374 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
10375
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010376 Supported in default-server: No
10377
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010378observe <mode>
10379 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
10380 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
10381 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
10382 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
10383 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
10384 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010010385 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010386
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010387 Supported in default-server: No
10388
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010389 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
10390
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010391on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010392 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
10393 Currently, four modes are available:
10394 - fastinter: force fastinter
10395 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
10396 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
10397 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
10398 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
10399
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010400 Supported in default-server: Yes
10401
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010402 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
10403
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010404on-marked-down <action>
10405 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
10406 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010407 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
10408 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
10409 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
10410 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
10411 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
10412 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
10413 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
10414 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010415
10416 Actions are disabled by default
10417
10418 Supported in default-server: Yes
10419
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010420on-marked-up <action>
10421 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
10422 Currently one action is available:
10423 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
10424 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
10425 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
10426 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
10427 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
10428 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
10429 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
10430 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
10431
10432 Actions are disabled by default
10433
10434 Supported in default-server: Yes
10435
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010436port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010437 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
10438 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
10439 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
10440 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
10441 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
10442 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
10443
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010444 Supported in default-server: Yes
10445
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010446redir <prefix>
10447 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
10448 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
10449 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
10450 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
10451 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
10452 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
10453 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
10454 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010455 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010456 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
10457 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
10458 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
10459 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
10460 loop between the client and HAProxy!
10461
10462 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
10463
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010464 Supported in default-server: No
10465
10466rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010467 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
10468 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
10469 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
10470
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010471 Supported in default-server: Yes
10472
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010473resolve-prefer <family>
10474 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
10475 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
10476 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
10477 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
10478
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020010479 Default value: ipv6
10480
10481 Supported in default-server: Yes
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010482
10483 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
10484
10485resolvers <id>
10486 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
10487 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010488 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
10489 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
10490 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
10491 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010492
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010493 Supported in default-server: No
10494
10495 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010496
10497 See also chapter 5.3
10498
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010499send-proxy
10500 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
10501 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
10502 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
10503 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
10504 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
10505 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
10506 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
10507 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
10508 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010509 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
10510 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
10511 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
10512 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
10513 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010514
10515 Supported in default-server: No
10516
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040010517send-proxy-v2
10518 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
10519 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10520 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10521 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10522 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
10523 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
10524 option of the "bind" keyword.
10525
10526 Supported in default-server: No
10527
10528send-proxy-v2-ssl
10529 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10530 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10531 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10532 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10533 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10534 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
10535 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
10536 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10537
10538 Supported in default-server: No
10539
10540send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
10541 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10542 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10543 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10544 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10545 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10546 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
10547 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
10548 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
10549 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10550
10551 Supported in default-server: No
10552
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010553slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010554 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
10555 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
10556 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
10557 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
10558 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
10559 parameters :
10560
10561 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
10562 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
10563
10564 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
10565 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
10566 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
10567 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
10568
10569 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
10570 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
10571 seen as failed.
10572
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010573 Supported in default-server: Yes
10574
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020010575sni <expression>
10576 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
10577 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
10578 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
10579 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
10580 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
10581
10582 Supported in default-server: no
10583
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010584source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010585source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010586source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010587 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
10588 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
10589 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
10590 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
10591
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010592 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
10593 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
10594 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
10595 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
10596 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
10597 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
10598 server.
10599
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010600 Supported in default-server: No
10601
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010602ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010603 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
10604 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
10605 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
10606 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
10607 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
10608 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010609 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010610
10611 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010612
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020010613tcp-ut <delay>
10614 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
10615 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
10616 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
10617 acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
10618 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
10619 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
10620 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
10621 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
10622 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
10623 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
10624 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
10625 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
10626 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10627
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010628track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020010629 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
10630 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
10631 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
10632 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010633 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
10634
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010635 Supported in default-server: No
10636
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010637verify [none|required]
10638 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010010639 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
10640 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
10641 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
10642 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010643 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
10644 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
10645 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010646
10647 Supported in default-server: No
10648
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070010649verifyhost <hostname>
10650 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
10651 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
10652 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
10653 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
10654 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
10655 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
10656
10657 Supported in default-server: No
10658
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010659weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010660 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
10661 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
10662 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020010663 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
10664 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
10665 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
10666 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
10667 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
10668 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010669
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010670 Supported in default-server: Yes
10671
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010672
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200106735.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
10674-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010675
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010676HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
10677using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
10678configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010679This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
10680can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
10681workload.
10682This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
10683resolution at run time.
10684Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
10685carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
10686
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010687Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
10688health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
10689
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010690
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200106915.3.1. Global overview
10692----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010693
10694As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
10695different steps of the process life:
10696
10697 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
10698 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
10699 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
10700
10701 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
10702 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
10703 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
10704
10705A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
10706 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
10707 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
10708 resolution to know this new IP.
10709
10710A few things important to notice:
10711 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
10712 first valid response.
10713
10714 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
10715 servers return an error.
10716
10717
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200107185.3.2. The resolvers section
10719----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010720
10721This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
10722HAProxy.
10723There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
10724many name servers.
10725
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010726When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
10727uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
10728is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
10729answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
10730
10731When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
10732used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
10733
10734Two types of behavior can be applied:
10735 1. stop DNS resolution
10736 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
10737 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
10738 1. ANY query type
10739 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
10740 server's parameter
10741 3. remaining family type
10742
10743HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
10744 - invalid DNS response packet
10745 - wrong name in the query section of the response
10746 - NX domain
10747 - Query refused by server
10748 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
10749
10750HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
10751 - no Answer records in the response
10752 - DNS response truncated
10753 - Error in DNS response
10754 - No expected DNS records found in the response
10755 - name server timeout
10756
10757For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
10758 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
10759 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
10760 applied;
10761 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
10762 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
10763 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
10764 stops resolution.
10765
10766
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010767resolvers <resolvers id>
10768 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
10769
10770A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
10771
10772nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
10773 DNS server description:
10774 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
10775 <ip> : IP address of the server
10776 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
10777
10778hold <status> <period>
10779 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
10780 on last resolution <status>
10781 <status> : last name resolution status. Only "valid" is accepted for now.
10782 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
10783 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
10784 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
10785
10786 Default value is 10s for "valid".
10787
10788 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
10789 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
10790 the healch check.
10791
10792resolve_retries <nb>
10793 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
10794 giving up.
10795 Default value: 3
10796
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010797 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
10798 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
10799 type.
10800
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010801timeout <event> <time>
10802 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
10803 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
10804 events available are:
10805 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
10806 been received.
10807 Default value: 1s
10808 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
10809 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
10810
10811Example of a resolvers section (with default values):
10812
10813 resolvers mydns
10814 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
10815 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
10816 resolve_retries 3
10817 timeout retry 1s
10818 hold valid 10s
10819
10820
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108216. HTTP header manipulation
10822---------------------------
10823
10824In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
10825response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
10826request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
10827which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010828against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010829
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010830If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
10831to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
10832but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
10833HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
10834stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
10835because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
10836a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
10837still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020010838
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010839This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
10840in section 4.2 :
10841
10842 - reqadd <string>
10843 - reqallow <search>
10844 - reqiallow <search>
10845 - reqdel <search>
10846 - reqidel <search>
10847 - reqdeny <search>
10848 - reqideny <search>
10849 - reqpass <search>
10850 - reqipass <search>
10851 - reqrep <search> <replace>
10852 - reqirep <search> <replace>
10853 - reqtarpit <search>
10854 - reqitarpit <search>
10855 - rspadd <string>
10856 - rspdel <search>
10857 - rspidel <search>
10858 - rspdeny <search>
10859 - rspideny <search>
10860 - rsprep <search> <replace>
10861 - rspirep <search> <replace>
10862
10863With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
10864is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
10865parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
10866prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
10867Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
10868
10869 \t for a tab
10870 \r for a carriage return (CR)
10871 \n for a new line (LF)
10872 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
10873 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
10874 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
10875 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
10876 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
10877
10878The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
10879portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
10880above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
10881regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
108829 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
10883is very common to users of the "sed" program.
10884
10885The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
10886after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
10887
10888Notes related to these keywords :
10889---------------------------------
10890 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
10891 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
10892 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
10893
10894 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
10895 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
10896 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
10897
10898 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
10899 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
10900 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
10901 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
10902 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
10903
10904 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
10905 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
10906 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
10907 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
10908 useless headers before adding new ones.
10909
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010910 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010911 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
10912
10913 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
10914 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
10915 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
10916
10917 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
10918 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010919 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010920
10921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200109227. Using ACLs and fetching samples
10923----------------------------------
10924
10925Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
10926client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
10927The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
10928these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
10929but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
10930data called patterns.
10931
10932
109337.1. ACL basics
10934---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010935
10936The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
10937content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
10938from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
10939simple :
10940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010941 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010942 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010943 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
10944 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010946The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
10947adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010948
10949In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
10950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010951 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010952
10953This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
10954Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
10955and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010956an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
10957conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
10958as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
10959are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010960
10961ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
10962'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
10963which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
10964
10965There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
10966performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
10967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010968The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
10969specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
10970this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010971methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
10972ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010973
10974Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
10975 - boolean
10976 - integer (signed or unsigned)
10977 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
10978 - string
10979 - data block
10980
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010981Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
10982converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
10983would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
10984The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
10985which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
10986
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010987Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
10988keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
10989fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
10990which are summarized in the table below :
10991
10992 +---------------------+-----------------+
10993 | Sample or converter | Default |
10994 | output type | matching method |
10995 +---------------------+-----------------+
10996 | boolean | bool |
10997 +---------------------+-----------------+
10998 | integer | int |
10999 +---------------------+-----------------+
11000 | ip | ip |
11001 +---------------------+-----------------+
11002 | string | str |
11003 +---------------------+-----------------+
11004 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11005 +---------------------+-----------------+
11006
11007Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11008matching method, see below.
11009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011010The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11011 - boolean
11012 - integer or integer range
11013 - IP address / network
11014 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11015 - regular expression
11016 - hex block
11017
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011018The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11019
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011020 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11021 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011022 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011023 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011024 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011025 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011026 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011028The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11029read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11030if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11031lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11032will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11033beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11034a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11035lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11036exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11037
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011038The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11039parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11040ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11041a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11042check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11043
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011044The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11045socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11046file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011048Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11049loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11050
11051 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11052
11053In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11054the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11055case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11056as well.
11057
11058The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11059sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11060do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11061methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11062is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11063obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11064followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11065default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11066that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11067string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11068
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011069The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11070By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11071string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11072resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11073server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11074waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11075flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11076function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011078There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11079sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11080be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011081
11082 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
11083 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011084 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
11085 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
11086 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
11087 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011088
11089 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
11090 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011091 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011092
11093 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011094 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011095
11096 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011097 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011098
11099 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
11100 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
11101
11102 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
11103 binary or string samples.
11104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011105 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
11106 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011108 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
11109 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
11110 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011112 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
11113 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011115 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
11116 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011118 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
11119 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011121 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
11122 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011123 This may be used with binary or string samples.
11124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011125 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
11126 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
11127 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011128
11129For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
11130request, it is possible to do :
11131
11132 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
11133
11134In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
11135buffer, one would use the following acl :
11136
11137 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
11138
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011139On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
11140possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
11141
11142 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
11143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011144All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
11145criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
11146method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
11147to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
11148criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
11149the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011151If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011152the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
11153For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011155 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
11156 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
11157 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
11158 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011159
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011160
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011161The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
11162types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
11163combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
11164brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
11165default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011167 +-------------------------------------------------+
11168 | Input sample type |
11169 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011170 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011171 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11172 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
11173 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011174 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011175 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011176 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011177 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011178 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011179 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011180 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011181 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011182 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011183 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011184 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011185 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011186 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011187 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011188 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011189 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011190 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011191 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011192 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011193 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011194 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011195 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11196 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
11197 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011198
11199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200112007.1.1. Matching booleans
11201------------------------
11202
11203In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
11204Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
11205When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
11206that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
11207
11208Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
11209return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
11210"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
11211
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200112137.1.2. Matching integers
11214------------------------
11215
11216Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
11217enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
11218to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
11219
11220Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
11221matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
11222lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011223
11224For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
11225unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
11226representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
11227
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011228As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
11229two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
11230instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
11231ranges and operators.
11232
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011233For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011234operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
11235Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
11236of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011237
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011238Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011239
11240 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
11241 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
11242 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
11243 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
11244 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
11245
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011246For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011247
11248 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
11249
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011250This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
11251
11252 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
11253
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200112557.1.3. Matching strings
11256-----------------------
11257
11258String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
11259different forms :
11260
11261 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
11262 patterns ;
11263
11264 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
11265 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
11266
11267 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
11268 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11269
11270 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
11271 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11272
11273 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
11274 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
11275 matches.
11276
11277 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
11278 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
11279 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011280
11281String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
11282exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
11283characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
11284string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
11285to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011286before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011287
11288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200112897.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
11290---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011291
11292Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
11293they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
11294possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
11295passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
11296the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011297the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
11298match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011299
11300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200113017.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
11302-------------------------------------
11303
11304It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
11305not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
11306a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
11307to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
11308digits may be used upper or lower case.
11309
11310Example :
11311 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
11312 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
11313
11314
113157.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
11316---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011317
11318IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
11319netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
11320within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011321host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011322difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
11323at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
11324does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
11325parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011326
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011327IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
11328Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
11329trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
11330IPv6 patterns.
11331
11332HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
11333following situations :
11334 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
11335 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
11336 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
11337 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
11338 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
11339 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
11340 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
11341 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
11342 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
11343 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
11344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011345
113467.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
11347----------------------------------
11348
11349Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
11350combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
11351
11352 - AND (implicit)
11353 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
11354 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011356A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011358 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011360Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
11361indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011363For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
11364"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
11365requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
11366is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
11367
11368 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11369 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
11370 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
11371 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
11372
11373To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
11374and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
11375
11376 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
11377 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
11378 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
11379 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
11380
11381 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
11382 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
11383 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
11384 use_backend www if host_www
11385
11386It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
11387expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
11388be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
11389the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
11390
11391 The following rule :
11392
11393 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11394 block if METH_POST missing_cl
11395
11396 Can also be written that way :
11397
11398 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
11399
11400It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
11401to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
11402simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
11403sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
11404good use is the following :
11405
11406 With named ACLs :
11407
11408 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
11409 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
11410 monitor fail if site_dead
11411
11412 With anonymous ACLs :
11413
11414 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
11415
11416See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
11417
11418
114197.3. Fetching samples
11420---------------------
11421
11422Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
11423against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
11424sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
11425ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
11426of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
11427available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
11428
11429This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
11430Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
11431compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
11432deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
11433
11434The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
11435matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
11436method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
11437indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
11438
11439As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
11440when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
11441mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
11442the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
11443ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
11444
11445Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
11446multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
11447when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
11448incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
11449are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
11450is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
11451all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
11452
11453Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
11454 - name
11455 - name(arg1)
11456 - name(arg1,arg2)
11457
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011458
114597.3.1. Converters
11460-----------------
11461
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011462Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
11463of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
11464is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
11465was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
11466has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
11467unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
11468
11469These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
11470sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
11471the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
11472support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011473
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011474A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
11475support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
11476supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
11477(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
11478bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
11479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011480The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011481
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011482add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011483 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011484 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
11485 name. The name of the variable starts by an indication about its scope. The
11486 allowed scopes are:
11487 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11488 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11489 response),
11490 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11491 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11492 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11493 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011494
11495and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011496 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011497 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
11498 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts by an
11499 indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11500 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11501 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11502 response),
11503 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11504 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11505 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11506 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011507
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020011508base64
11509 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
11510 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
11511 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
11512
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011513bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011514 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011515 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11516 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11517 presence of a flag).
11518
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010011519bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
11520 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
11521 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
11522 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
11523
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011524cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011525 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
11526 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011527
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011528crc32([<avalanche>])
11529 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
11530 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11531 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11532 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11533 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11534 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
11535 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
11536 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
11537 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
11538 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
11539 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
11540
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010011541da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011542 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
11543 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
11544 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
11545 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
11546 ('|'). There's a limit of 5 different properties imposed by the haproxy
11547 configuration language.
11548
11549 Example:
11550 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020011551 bind *:8881
11552 default_backend servers
11553 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011554
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020011555debug
11556 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
11557 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
11558 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
11559
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011560div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011561 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
11562 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011563 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
11564 variable name. The name of the variable starts by an indication about it
11565 scope. The scope allowed are:
11566 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11567 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11568 response),
11569 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11570 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11571 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11572 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011573
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011574djb2([<avalanche>])
11575 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
11576 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11577 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11578 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11579 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11580 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11581 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011582 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
11583 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011584
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011585even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011586 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011587 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
11588
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010011589field(<index>,<delimiters>)
11590 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
11591 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
11592 list of chars.
11593
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011594hex
11595 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
11596 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
11597 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
11598 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010011599
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011600http_date([<offset>])
11601 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11602 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
11603 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
11604 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
11605 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
11606 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011607
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011608in_table(<table>)
11609 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11610 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
11611 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
11612 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
11613 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
11614
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011615ipmask(<mask>)
11616 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
11617 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
11618 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
11619 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
11620
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020011621json([<input-code>])
11622 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
11623 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
11624 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
11625 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
11626 of errors:
11627 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
11628 bytes, ...)
11629 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
11630 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
11631
11632 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
11633 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
11634 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
11635 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
11636 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
11637 are :
11638 - "ascii" : never fails ;
11639 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
11640 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
11641 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
11642 error ;
11643 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
11644 characters corresponding to the other errors.
11645
11646 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
11647 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
11648
11649 Example:
11650 capture request header user-agent len 150
11651 capture request header Host len 15
11652 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
11653
11654 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
11655 GET / HTTP/1.0
11656 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
11657
11658 Output log:
11659 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
11660
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011661language(<value>[,<default>])
11662 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
11663 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
11664 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
11665 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
11666 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
11667 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
11668 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
11669 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
11670 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
11671 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
11672 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
11673 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011674
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011675 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011676
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011677 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
11678 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011679
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011680 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
11681 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
11682 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
11683 use_backend spanish if es
11684 use_backend french if fr
11685 use_backend english if en
11686 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011687
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011688lower
11689 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
11690 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
11691 type. The result is of type string.
11692
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020011693ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
11694 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11695 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
11696 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
11697 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
11698 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
11699 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
11700
11701 Example :
11702
11703 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
11704 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
11705 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
11706
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011707map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11708map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11709map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11710 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
11711 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
11712 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
11713 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
11714 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
11715 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
11716 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
11717 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011718
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011719 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
11720 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
11721 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011722
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011723 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
11724 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011725
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011726 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
11727 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11728 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
11729 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020011730 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
11731 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011732 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
11733 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11734 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
11735 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11736 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
11737 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11738 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
11739 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11740 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
11741 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11742 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
11743 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11744 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
11745 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011746
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011747 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
11748 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
11749 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
11750 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
11751 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011752
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011753 Example :
11754
11755 # this is a comment and is ignored
11756 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
11757 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
11758 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
11759 | | | `---------- value
11760 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
11761 | `---------------------------- key
11762 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
11763
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011764mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011765 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
11766 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011767 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
11768 starts by an indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11769 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11770 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11771 response),
11772 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11773 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11774 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11775 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011776
11777mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011778 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020011779 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
11780 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011781 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
11782 starts by an indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11783 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11784 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11785 response),
11786 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11787 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11788 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11789 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011790
11791neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011792 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
11793 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
11794 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
11795 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011796
11797not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011798 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011799 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11800 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11801 absence of a flag).
11802
11803odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011804 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011805 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
11806
11807or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011808 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011809 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
11810 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts by an
11811 indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
11812 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11813 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11814 response),
11815 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11816 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11817 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11818 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011819
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010011820regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010011821 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
11822 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
11823 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
11824 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
11825 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
11826 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
11827 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
11828 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
11829 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
11830 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
11831 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis or comma
11832 are not possible to use in the arguments. The first use of this converter is
11833 to replace certain characters or sequence of characters with other ones.
11834
11835 Example :
11836
11837 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
11838 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
11839 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
11840 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
11841
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020011842capture-req(<id>)
11843 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
11844 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
11845
11846 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
11847 "http-response capture", "req.hdr.capture" and
11848 "res.hdr.capture" (sample fetches).
11849
11850capture-res(<id>)
11851 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
11852 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
11853
11854 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
11855 "http-response capture", "req.hdr.capture" and
11856 "res.hdr.capture" (sample fetches).
11857
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011858sdbm([<avalanche>])
11859 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
11860 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11861 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11862 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11863 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11864 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11865 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011866 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
11867 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011868
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011869set-var(<var name>)
11870 Sets a variable with the input content and return the content on the output as
11871 is. The variable keep the value and the associated input type. The name of the
11872 variable starts by an indication about it scope. The scope allowed are:
11873 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11874 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11875 response),
11876 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11877 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11878 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11879 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
11880
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011881sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011882 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
11883 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011884 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
11885 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
11886 scope. The allowed scopes are:
11887 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
11888 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
11889 response),
11890 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
11891 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
11892 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
11893 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011894
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011895table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
11896 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11897 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11898 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
11899 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
11900 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
11901 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
11902
11903
11904table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
11905 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11906 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11907 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
11908 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
11909 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
11910 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
11911
11912table_conn_cnt(<table>)
11913 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11914 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11915 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
11916 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
11917 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11918
11919table_conn_cur(<table>)
11920 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11921 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11922 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
11923 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
11924 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
11925
11926table_conn_rate(<table>)
11927 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11928 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11929 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
11930 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
11931 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
11932
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011933table_gpt0(<table>)
11934 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11935 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
11936 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
11937 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
11938 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
11939
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011940table_gpc0(<table>)
11941 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11942 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11943 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
11944 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
11945 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
11946
11947table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
11948 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11949 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11950 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
11951 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
11952 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
11953 sample fetch keyword.
11954
11955table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
11956 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11957 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11958 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
11959 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
11960 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11961
11962table_http_err_rate(<table>)
11963 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11964 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11965 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
11966 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
11967 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
11968 keyword.
11969
11970table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
11971 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11972 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11973 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
11974 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
11975 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
11976
11977table_http_req_rate(<table>)
11978 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11979 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11980 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
11981 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
11982 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
11983 keyword.
11984
11985table_kbytes_in(<table>)
11986 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11987 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11988 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
11989 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
11990 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
11991 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
11992 keyword.
11993
11994table_kbytes_out(<table>)
11995 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11996 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
11997 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
11998 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
11999 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12000 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
12001 keyword.
12002
12003table_server_id(<table>)
12004 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12005 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12006 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12007 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12008 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12009 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12010
12011table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12012 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12013 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12014 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12015 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12016 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12017 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12018 keyword.
12019
12020table_sess_rate(<table>)
12021 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12022 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12023 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12024 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12025 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12026 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12027 keyword.
12028
12029table_trackers(<table>)
12030 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12031 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12032 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12033 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
12034 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
12035 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
12036 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
12037 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
12038 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
12039 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
12040
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012041upper
12042 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
12043 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12044 type. The result is of type string.
12045
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020012046url_dec
12047 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
12048 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
12049
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012050utime(<format>[,<offset>])
12051 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12052 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
12053 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12054 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12055 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12056 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
12057
12058 Example :
12059
12060 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
12061 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12062 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12063
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010012064word(<index>,<delimiters>)
12065 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
12066 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
12067
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012068wt6([<avalanche>])
12069 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
12070 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12071 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12072 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12073 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12074 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12075 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012076 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
12077 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012078
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012079xor(<value>)
12080 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012081 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012082 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
12083 starts by an indication about its scope. The allowed scopes are:
12084 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
12085 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
12086 response),
12087 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
12088 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
12089 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12090 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012091
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012092
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200120937.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012094--------------------------------------------
12095
12096A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
12097not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
12098"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
12099The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
12100
12101always_false : boolean
12102 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12103 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12104
12105always_true : boolean
12106 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12107 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12108
12109avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012110 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012111 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
12112 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
12113 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
12114 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
12115 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
12116 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
12117 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
12118 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
12119 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
12120 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
12121 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
12122 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
12123 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010012124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012125be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012126 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
12127 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
12128 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
12129 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
12130 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012132be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
12133 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12134 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12135 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
12136 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
12137 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
12138 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012139
12140 Example :
12141 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
12142 backend dynamic
12143 mode http
12144 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
12145 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012146
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012147bin(<hexa>) : bin
12148 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
12149 of the string.
12150
12151bool(<bool>) : bool
12152 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
12153 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
12154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012155connslots([<backend>]) : integer
12156 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012157 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012158 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
12159 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050012160
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012161 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012162 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012163 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
12164
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012165 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
12166 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012167
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012168 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012169 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012170 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012171 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
12172 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012173 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012174 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012175
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012176 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
12177 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012178 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012179 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012180
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012181date([<offset>]) : integer
12182 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
12183 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
12184 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
12185 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020012186 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
12187
12188 Example :
12189
12190 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
12191 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012192
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020012193env(<name>) : string
12194 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
12195 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
12196 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
12197 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
12198 certain way.
12199
12200 Examples :
12201 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
12202 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
12203
12204 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
12205 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
12206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012207fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
12208 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012209 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
12210 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012211 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
12212 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
12213 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
12214 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
12215 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012217fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
12218 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12219 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12220 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
12221 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
12222 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
12223 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
12224 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
12225 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012226
12227 Example :
12228 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
12229 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
12230 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
12231 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
12232 frontend mail
12233 bind :25
12234 mode tcp
12235 maxconn 100
12236 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
12237 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
12238 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
12239 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012240
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012241int(<integer>) : signed integer
12242 Returns a signed integer.
12243
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012244ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
12245 Returns an ipv4.
12246
12247ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
12248 Returns an ipv6.
12249
12250meth(<method>) : method
12251 Returns a method.
12252
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012253nbproc : integer
12254 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
12255 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
12256 and debugging purposes.
12257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012258nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
12259 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
12260 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
12261 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012262 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
12263 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
12264 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012265
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012266proc : integer
12267 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
12268 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
12269 debugging purposes.
12270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012271queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012272 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
12273 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
12274 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012275 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
12276 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
12277 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
12278 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
12279 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
12280
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010012281rand([<range>]) : integer
12282 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
12283 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
12284 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
12285 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
12286 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
12287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012288srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12289 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12290 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
12291 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
12292 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
12293 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
12294 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
12295 methods.
12296
12297srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
12298 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
12299 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
12300 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
12301 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
12302 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
12303 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
12304 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
12305
12306srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12307 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12308 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012309 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012310 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
12311 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
12312 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
12313 overloading servers).
12314
12315 Example :
12316 # Redirect to a separate back
12317 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
12318 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
12319 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
12320
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012321stopping : boolean
12322 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
12323 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
12324 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
12325
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012326str(<string>) : string
12327 Returns a string.
12328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012329table_avl([<table>]) : integer
12330 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
12331 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
12332
12333table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12334 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
12335 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
12336 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
12337
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012338var(<var-name>) : undefined
12339 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
12340 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts by an indication about its
12341 scope. The scope allowed are:
12342 "sess" : the variable is shared with all the session,
12343 "txn" : the variable is shared with all the transaction (request and
12344 response),
12345 "req" : the variable is shared only during the request processing,
12346 "res" : the variable is shared only during the response processing.
12347 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12348 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012350
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200123517.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012352----------------------------------
12353
12354The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
12355closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
12356methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
12357sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
12358TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012359the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
12360counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
12361"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012362argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
12363the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
12364this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012365
12366be_id : integer
12367 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
12368 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
12369
12370dst : ip
12371 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
12372 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
12373 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
12374 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
12375 RFC 4291.
12376
12377dst_conn : integer
12378 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12379 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
12380 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
12381 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
12382 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
12383 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
12384 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
12385 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012387dst_port : integer
12388 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
12389 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
12390 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
12391 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
12392 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
12393 an HTTP header.
12394
12395fe_id : integer
12396 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
12397 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
12398 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
12399
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012400sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012401sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12402sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12403sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012404 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
12405 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12406 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
12407
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012408sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012409sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12410sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12411sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012412 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
12413 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12414 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
12415
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012416sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012417sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12418sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12419sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012420 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
12421 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012422 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
12423 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
12424 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012425
12426 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12427 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012428 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12429 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
12430 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012431 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12432 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12433
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012434sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012435sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12436sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12437sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012438 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
12439 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
12440
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012441sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012442sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12443sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12444sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012445 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12446 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
12447 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
12448
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012449sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012450sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12451sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12452sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012453 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
12454 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
12455 See also src_conn_rate.
12456
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012457sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012458sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12459sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12460sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012461 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012462 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012463
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012464sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
12465sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12466sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12467sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12468 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
12469 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
12470
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012471sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012472sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12473sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12474sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012475 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
12476 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
12477 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012478 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
12479 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
12480 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012481
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012482sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012483sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12484sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12485sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012486 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
12487 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
12488 See also src_http_err_cnt.
12489
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012490sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012491sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12492sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12493sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012494 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
12495 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
12496 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
12497 src_http_err_rate.
12498
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012499sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012500sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12501sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12502sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012503 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12504 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12505 src_http_req_cnt.
12506
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012507sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012508sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12509sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12510sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012511 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12512 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
12513 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12514 src_http_req_rate.
12515
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012516sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012517sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12518sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12519sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012520 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012521 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
12522 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
12523 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
12524 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012525
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012526 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12527 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012528 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12529
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012530sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012531sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12532sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12533sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012534 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
12535 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12536 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012537
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012538sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012539sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12540sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12541sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012542 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
12543 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12544 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012545
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012546sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012547sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12548sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12549sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012550 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
12551 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
12552 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
12553 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012554 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012555 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
12556
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012557sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012558sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12559sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12560sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012561 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
12562 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12563 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
12564 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
12565 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012566 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012567
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012568sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012569sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12570sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12571sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020012572 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
12573 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
12574 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
12575
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012576sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012577sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12578sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12579sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012580 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12581 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012582 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012583 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
12584 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012585 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
12586 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
12587 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012589so_id : integer
12590 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
12591 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
12592 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012594src : ip
12595 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
12596 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
12597 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
12598 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
12599 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
12600 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
12601 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012602
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012603 Example:
12604 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
12605 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
12606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012607src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12608 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
12609 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
12610 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012611 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012613src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12614 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
12615 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012616 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012617 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012619src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12620 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12621 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12622 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
12623 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
12624 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
12625 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012626
12627 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12628 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
12629 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
12630 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012631 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012632 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12633 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012635src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012636 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012637 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012638 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012639 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012641src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012642 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012643 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
12644 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012645 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012647src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12648 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
12649 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12650 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012651 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012653src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012654 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012655 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012656 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012657 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012658
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012659src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12660 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
12661 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
12662 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
12663 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
12664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012665src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012666 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012667 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012668 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
12669 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012670 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
12671 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
12672 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012674src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12675 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
12676 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012677 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012678 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012679 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012681src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12682 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
12683 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12684 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
12685 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012686 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012688src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12689 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
12690 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
12691 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012692 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012694src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12695 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
12696 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
12697 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012698 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012699 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012701src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12702 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12703 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12704 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012705 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012706 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
12707 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012708
12709 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012710 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012711 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012713src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012714 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
12715 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
12716 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
12717 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
12718 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012720src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012721 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
12722 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12723 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
12724 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
12725 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012727src_port : integer
12728 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
12729 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
12730 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
12731 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012733src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12734 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012735 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12736 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
12737 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012738 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012740src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12741 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
12742 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12743 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12744 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012745 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012747src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12748 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
12749 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
12750 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
12751 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
12752 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
12753 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
12754 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
12755 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012756
12757 Example :
12758 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
12759 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
12760 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
12761 listen ssh
12762 bind :22
12763 mode tcp
12764 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012765 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012766 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012767 server local 127.0.0.1:22
12768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012769srv_id : integer
12770 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
12771 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
12772 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020012773
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010012774
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200127757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012776----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020012777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012778The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
12779closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
12780when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
12781usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012782future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020012783
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012784ssl_bc : boolean
12785 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
12786 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
12787 other a server with the "ssl" option.
12788
12789ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
12790 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
12791 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12792
12793ssl_bc_cipher : string
12794 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
12795 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12796
12797ssl_bc_protocol : string
12798 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
12799 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12800
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012801ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012802 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020012803 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
12804 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012805
12806ssl_bc_session_id : binary
12807 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
12808 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
12809 if session was reused or not.
12810
12811ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
12812 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
12813 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012815ssl_c_ca_err : integer
12816 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12817 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
12818 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
12819 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
12820 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020012821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012822ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
12823 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12824 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
12825 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
12826 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012827
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010012828ssl_c_der : binary
12829 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
12830 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12831 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
12832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012833ssl_c_err : integer
12834 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12835 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
12836 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
12837 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
12838 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012840ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12841 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12842 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
12843 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12844 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12845 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12846 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12847 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12848 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012850ssl_c_key_alg : string
12851 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
12852 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12853 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012855ssl_c_notafter : string
12856 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
12857 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12858 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020012859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012860ssl_c_notbefore : string
12861 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
12862 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12863 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010012864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012865ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12866 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12867 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
12868 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12869 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12870 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12871 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12872 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12873 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010012874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012875ssl_c_serial : binary
12876 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
12877 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12878 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012880ssl_c_sha1 : binary
12881 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
12882 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
12883 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020012884 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
12885 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
12886
12887 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012889ssl_c_sig_alg : string
12890 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
12891 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
12892 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012894ssl_c_used : boolean
12895 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
12896 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012898ssl_c_verify : integer
12899 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
12900 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
12901 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
12902 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012904ssl_c_version : integer
12905 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
12906 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012907
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010012908ssl_f_der : binary
12909 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
12910 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12911 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
12912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012913ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12914 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12915 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
12916 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12917 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012918 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012919 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12920 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12921 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012923ssl_f_key_alg : string
12924 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
12925 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
12926 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012928ssl_f_notafter : string
12929 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
12930 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12931 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012933ssl_f_notbefore : string
12934 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
12935 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
12936 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012938ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
12939 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
12940 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
12941 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
12942 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
12943 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
12944 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
12945 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
12946 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020012947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012948ssl_f_serial : binary
12949 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
12950 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
12951 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020012952
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020012953ssl_f_sha1 : binary
12954 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
12955 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
12956 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
12957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012958ssl_f_sig_alg : string
12959 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
12960 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
12961 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020012962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012963ssl_f_version : integer
12964 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
12965 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12966
12967ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012968 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
12969 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
12970 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
12971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012972 Example :
12973 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
12974 listen http-https
12975 bind :80
12976 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
12977 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
12978
12979ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
12980 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
12981 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12982
12983ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012984 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012985 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
12986 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
12987 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
12988 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
12989 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
12990 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
12991 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
12992 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
12993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012994ssl_fc_cipher : string
12995 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
12996 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012998ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020012999 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
13000 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010013001 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
13002 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
13003 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
13004 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013006ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
13007 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020013008 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
13009 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
13010 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13011 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013012
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020013013ssl_fc_is_resumed: boolean
13014 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
13015 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
13016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013017ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013018 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013019 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
13020 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
13021 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13022 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
13023 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
13024 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
13025 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020013026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013027ssl_fc_protocol : string
13028 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
13029 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013030
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013031ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013032 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013033 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13034 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013036ssl_fc_session_id : binary
13037 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
13038 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
13039 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
13040 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013042ssl_fc_sni : string
13043 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
13044 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
13045 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
13046 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
13047 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
13048
13049 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
13050 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
13051 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020013052 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
13053 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013055 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013056 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
13057 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020013058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013059ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
13060 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
13061 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013062
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013063
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200130647.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013065------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013067Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
13068sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
13069only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
13070For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
13071be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
13072can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
13073sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
13074for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
13075content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013077payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
13078 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
13079 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
13080 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013082payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
13083 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
13084 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
13085 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013087req.len : integer
13088req_len : integer (deprecated)
13089 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13090 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13091 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13092 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13093 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13094 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13095 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
13096 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013098req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13099 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013100 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13101 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13102 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13103 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013105 ACL alternatives :
13106 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013108req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13109 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13110 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13111 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
13112 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013114 ACL alternatives :
13115 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013117 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013119req.proto_http : boolean
13120req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
13121 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
13122 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
13123 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
13124 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
13125 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
13126 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
13127 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013129 Example:
13130 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13131 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13132 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013133 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013135req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
13136rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13137 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
13138 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
13139 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
13140 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
13141 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
13142 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
13143 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013145 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
13146 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
13147 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
13148 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
13149 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
13150 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013152 ACL derivatives :
13153 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013155 Example :
13156 listen tse-farm
13157 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
13158 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
13159 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13160 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
13161 # apply RDP cookie persistence
13162 persist rdp-cookie
13163 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
13164 # This is only useful makes sense if
13165 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
13166 stick-table type string size 204800
13167 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
13168 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
13169 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013171 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
13172 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013174req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
13175rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
13176 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
13177 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
13178 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
13179 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013181 ACL derivatives :
13182 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013183
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013184req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
13185 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
13186 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013187 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
13188 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
13189 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
13190 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
13191 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013193req.ssl_hello_type : integer
13194req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13195 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13196 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
13197 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13198 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13199 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
13200 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13201 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013203req.ssl_sni : string
13204req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
13205 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
13206 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
13207 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
13208 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13209 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13210 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
13211 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
13212 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
13213 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
13214 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
13215 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
13216 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013218 ACL derivatives :
13219 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013221 Examples :
13222 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
13223 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13224 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
13225 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
13226 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013227
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053013228req.ssl_st_ext : integer
13229 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
13230 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
13231 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
13232 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
13233 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
13234 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
13235 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
13236 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
13237 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
13238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013239req.ssl_ver : integer
13240req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
13241 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
13242 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
13243 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
13244 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
13245 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13246 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13247 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
13248 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
13249 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013251 ACL derivatives :
13252 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013253
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020013254res.len : integer
13255 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13256 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13257 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13258 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13259 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13260 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13261 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
13262 content inspection.
13263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013264res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13265 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013266 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13267 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13268 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13269 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013271res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13272 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13273 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13274 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
13275 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013277 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013278
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020013279res.ssl_hello_type : integer
13280rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13281 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13282 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
13283 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13284 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13285 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
13286 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13287 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
13288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013289wait_end : boolean
13290 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
13291 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
13292 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
13293 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
13294 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
13295 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
13296 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
13297 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013299 Examples :
13300 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
13301 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
13302 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013304 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
13305 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13306 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
13307 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
13308 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
13309 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
13310 tcp-request content reject
13311
13312
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200133137.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013314--------------------------------------
13315
13316It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
13317This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
13318data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
13319its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
13320HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
13321content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
13322to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
13323more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
13324response are indexed.
13325
13326base : string
13327 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
13328 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
13329 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
13330 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
13331 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
13332 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
13333 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
13334 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
13335
13336 ACL derivatives :
13337 base : exact string match
13338 base_beg : prefix match
13339 base_dir : subdir match
13340 base_dom : domain match
13341 base_end : suffix match
13342 base_len : length match
13343 base_reg : regex match
13344 base_sub : substring match
13345
13346base32 : integer
13347 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
13348 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
13349 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013350 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
13351 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
13352 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013353
13354base32+src : binary
13355 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
13356 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
13357 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
13358 per-URL counters.
13359
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013360capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
13361 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
13362 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13363 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
13364
13365capture.req.method : string
13366 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
13367 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
13368 because it's allocated.
13369
13370capture.req.uri : string
13371 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
13372 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
13373 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
13374 allocated.
13375
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013376capture.req.ver : string
13377 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13378 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
13379 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
13380
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013381capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
13382 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
13383 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13384 The first entry is an index of 0.
13385 See also: "capture response header"
13386
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013387capture.res.ver : string
13388 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13389 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
13390 persistent flag.
13391
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013392req.body : binary
13393 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
13394 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13395 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
13396 the first chunk is analyzed.
13397
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020013398req.body_param([<name>) : string
13399 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
13400 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
13401 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
13402 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
13403 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
13404 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
13405 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
13406 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
13407 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
13408 given.
13409
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013410req.body_len : integer
13411 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
13412 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
13413 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13414 "option http-buffer-request".
13415
13416req.body_size : integer
13417 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
13418 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
13419 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
13420 that the request body has been buffered made available using
13421 "option http-buffer-request".
13422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013423req.cook([<name>]) : string
13424cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13425 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13426 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13427 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
13428 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
13429 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
13430 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
13431 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
13432 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
13433
13434 ACL derivatives :
13435 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
13436 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
13437 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
13438 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
13439 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
13440 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
13441 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
13442 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013444req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13445cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13446 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13447 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013449req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13450cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13451 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13452 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
13453 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
13454 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013456cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13457 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13458 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
13459 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
13460 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020013461 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013462 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
13463 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
13464 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
13465 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013467hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13468 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
13469 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
13470 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
13471 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013472 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013474req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
13475 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13476 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13477 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13478 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13479 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13480 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
13481 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
13482 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013484req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13485 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13486 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13487 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
13488 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013490req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13491 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13492 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13493 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13494 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13495 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13496 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
13497 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
13498 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
13499 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
13500 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
13501 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013503 ACL derivatives :
13504 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
13505 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
13506 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
13507 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
13508 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
13509 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
13510 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
13511 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
13512
13513req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13514hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
13515 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13516 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
13517 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
13518 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
13519 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
13520 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
13521 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
13522 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
13523 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
13524
13525req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
13526hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
13527 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
13528 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
13529 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
13530 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
13531 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
13532 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
13533 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
13534 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
13535
13536req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
13537hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
13538 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
13539 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
13540 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
13541 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13542 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13543 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13544 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
13545
13546http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
13547 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
13548 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
13549 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13550 basic auth is supported.
13551
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013552http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
13553 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
13554 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
13555 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
13556 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013557 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13558 basic auth is supported.
13559
13560 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013561 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
13562 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
13563 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
13564 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013565
13566http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020013567 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
13568 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013569 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
13570 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020013571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013572method : integer + string
13573 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
13574 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
13575 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
13576 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
13577 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
13578 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
13579 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013581 ACL derivatives :
13582 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013584 Example :
13585 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
13586 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
13587 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013589path : string
13590 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
13591 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
13592 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
13593 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
13594 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
13595 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
13596 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013598 ACL derivatives :
13599 path : exact string match
13600 path_beg : prefix match
13601 path_dir : subdir match
13602 path_dom : domain match
13603 path_end : suffix match
13604 path_len : length match
13605 path_reg : regex match
13606 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013607
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010013608query : string
13609 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
13610 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
13611 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
13612 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
13613 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
13614 which stops before the question mark.
13615
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010013616req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
13617 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
13618 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
13619 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
13620 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013622req.ver : string
13623req_ver : string (deprecated)
13624 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
13625 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
13626 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013628 ACL derivatives :
13629 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013631res.comp : boolean
13632 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
13633 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
13634 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013636res.comp_algo : string
13637 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
13638 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
13639 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013641res.cook([<name>]) : string
13642scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13643 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13644 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13645 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013647 ACL derivatives :
13648 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013650res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13651scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13652 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13653 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
13654 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013656res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13657scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13658 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13659 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
13660 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013662res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13663 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
13664 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
13665 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
13666 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
13667 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
13668 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
13669 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
13670 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
13671 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013673res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13674 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
13675 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13676 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
13677 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
13678 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013680res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13681shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
13682 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
13683 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
13684 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
13685 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
13686 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
13687 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
13688 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
13689 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013691 ACL derivatives :
13692 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
13693 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
13694 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
13695 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
13696 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
13697 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
13698 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
13699 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
13700
13701res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13702shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13703 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
13704 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13705 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
13706 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
13707 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013709res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
13710shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
13711 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
13712 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
13713 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
13714 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
13715 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
13716 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013717
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010013718res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
13719 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
13720 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
13721 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
13722 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013724res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
13725shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
13726 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
13727 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
13728 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
13729 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
13730 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
13731 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010013732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013733res.ver : string
13734resp_ver : string (deprecated)
13735 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
13736 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013738 ACL derivatives :
13739 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010013740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013741set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13742 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13743 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020013744 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013745 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013747 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
13748 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013750status : integer
13751 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
13752 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
13753 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013755url : string
13756 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
13757 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
13758 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
13759 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
13760 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
13761 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
13762 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013764 ACL derivatives :
13765 url : exact string match
13766 url_beg : prefix match
13767 url_dir : subdir match
13768 url_dom : domain match
13769 url_end : suffix match
13770 url_len : length match
13771 url_reg : regex match
13772 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013774url_ip : ip
13775 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
13776 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
13777 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
13778 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
13779 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
13780 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
13781 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013783url_port : integer
13784 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
13785 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
13786 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
13787 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013788
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013789urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
13790url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013791 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
13792 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013793 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
13794 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
13795 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
13796 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013797 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
13798 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013799 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
13800 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013802 ACL derivatives :
13803 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
13804 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
13805 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
13806 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
13807 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
13808 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
13809 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
13810 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013811
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013813 Example :
13814 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
13815 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
13816 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
13817 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013818
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013819urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013820 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
13821 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
13822 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020013823
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010013824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200138257.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013826---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013827
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013828Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
13829every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013830order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013831
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013832ACL name Equivalent to Usage
13833---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013834FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020013835HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013836HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
13837HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013838HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
13839HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
13840HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
13841HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
13842LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013843METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
13844METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
13845METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
13846METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
13847METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
13848METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013849RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013850REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013851TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013852WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
13853---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010013854
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010013855
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138568. Logging
13857----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013858
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013859One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
13860provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
13861very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
13862provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
13863state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013864to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013865headers.
13866
13867In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
13868about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
13869send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
13870
13871 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
13872 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
13873 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
13874 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
13875 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060013876 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
13877 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013878
13879The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
13880allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
13881as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
13882while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
13883real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
13884delay.
13885
13886
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138878.1. Log levels
13888---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013889
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013890TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013891source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013892HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
13893in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
13894track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
13895syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
13896about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013897
13898
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138998.2. Log formats
13900----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013901
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013902HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090013903and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
13904slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
13905options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013906
13907 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
13908 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
13909 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
13910 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
13911 extents.
13912
13913 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
13914 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
13915 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
13916 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
13917 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
13918
13919 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
13920 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
13921 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
13922 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
13923 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
13924
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020013925 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
13926 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
13927 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
13928 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
13929
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013930 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
13931
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013932Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
13933specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
13934field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
13935servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
13936always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
13937identifier.
13938
13939Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
13940 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
13941 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
13942 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
13943 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
13944
13945
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139468.2.1. Default log format
13947-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013948
13949This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
13950as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
13951format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
13952
13953 Example :
13954 listen www
13955 mode http
13956 log global
13957 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
13958
13959 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
13960 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
13961 (www/HTTP)
13962
13963 Field Format Extract from the example above
13964 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
13965 2 'Connect from' Connect from
13966 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
13967 4 'to' to
13968 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
13969 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
13970
13971Detailed fields description :
13972 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
13973 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
13974 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
13975 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
13976 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
13977 and processed the connection.
13978 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
13979
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010013980In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
13981"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
13982connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
13983
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013984It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
13985will eventually disappear.
13986
13987
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139888.2.2. TCP log format
13989---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013990
13991The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
13992is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
13993information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
13994counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
13995emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
13996environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
13997the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
13998sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013999specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
14000not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
14001fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
14002marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014003
14004 Example :
14005 frontend fnt
14006 mode tcp
14007 option tcplog
14008 log global
14009 default_backend bck
14010
14011 backend bck
14012 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14013
14014 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
14015 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
14016 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
14017
14018 Field Format Extract from the example above
14019 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
14020 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
14021 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
14022 4 frontend_name fnt
14023 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
14024 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
14025 7 bytes_read* 212
14026 8 termination_state --
14027 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
14028 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14029
14030Detailed fields description :
14031 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014032 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14033 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14034 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
14035 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
14036 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014037
14038 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014039 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14040 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14041 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014042
14043 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
14044 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
14045 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
14046 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
14047
14048 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14049 and processed the connection.
14050
14051 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14052 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14053 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
14054 applications.
14055
14056 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14057 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14058 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14059 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
14060 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
14061
14062 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14063 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14064 See "Timers" below for more details.
14065
14066 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14067 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14068 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
14069 "Timers" below for more details.
14070
14071 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014072 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014073 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
14074 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
14075 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
14076 details.
14077
14078 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
14079 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
14080 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
14081 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
14082 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
14083
14084 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14085 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14086 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
14087 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
14088 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
14089 for more details.
14090
14091 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014092 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014093 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
14094 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
14095 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014096 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014097
14098 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14099 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14100 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14101 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14102 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14103 caused by a denial of service attack.
14104
14105 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14106 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14107 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14108 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14109 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14110 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14111 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14112 denial of service attack.
14113
14114 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14115 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14116 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14117 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14118 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14119 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14120 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14121 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
14122 be processed than on other servers.
14123
14124 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14125 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14126 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14127 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14128 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14129 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14130 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14131 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14132 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14133 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14134 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14135 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14136 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14137
14138 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14139 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14140 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14141 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14142 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14143 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14144 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14145 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14146
14147 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14148 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14149 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14150 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14151 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14152 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14153 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14154 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14155 occurs.
14156
14157
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141588.2.3. HTTP log format
14159----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014160
14161The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
14162is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
14163the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
14164are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
14165emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
14166generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
14167"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
14168which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014169frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
14170is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014171
14172Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
14173slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
14174with a star ('*') after the field name below.
14175
14176 Example :
14177 frontend http-in
14178 mode http
14179 option httplog
14180 log global
14181 default_backend bck
14182
14183 backend static
14184 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14185
14186 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
14187 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
14188 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014189 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014190
14191 Field Format Extract from the example above
14192 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
14193 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
14194 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
14195 4 frontend_name http-in
14196 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
14197 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
14198 7 status_code 200
14199 8 bytes_read* 2750
14200 9 captured_request_cookie -
14201 10 captured_response_cookie -
14202 11 termination_state ----
14203 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
14204 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14205 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
14206 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
14207 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014208
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014209
14210Detailed fields description :
14211 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014212 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14213 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14214 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
14215 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
14216 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014217
14218 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014219 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14220 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14221 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014222
14223 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
14224 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
14225 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
14226 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
14227 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
14228
14229 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14230 and processed the connection.
14231
14232 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14233 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14234 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
14235
14236 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14237 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14238 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14239 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
14240 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
14241 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
14242
14243 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
14244 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
14245 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
14246 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
14247 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
14248 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
14249
14250 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14251 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14252 See "Timers" below for more details.
14253
14254 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14255 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14256 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
14257 below for more details.
14258
14259 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
14260 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
14261 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
14262 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
14263 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
14264 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
14265 for more details.
14266
14267 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014268 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014269 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
14270 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
14271 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
14272 details.
14273
14274 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
14275 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
14276 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
14277
14278 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
14279 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
14280 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
14281 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
14282 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
14283 overflowing.
14284
14285 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
14286 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
14287 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
14288 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
14289 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
14290 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
14291 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
14292 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14293
14294 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
14295 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
14296 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
14297 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
14298 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
14299 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
14300 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
14301 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14302
14303 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14304 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14305 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
14306 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
14307 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
14308 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
14309 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
14310
14311 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014312 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014313 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
14314 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
14315 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014316 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014317 system.
14318
14319 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14320 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14321 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14322 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14323 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14324 caused by a denial of service attack.
14325
14326 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14327 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14328 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14329 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14330 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14331 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14332 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14333 denial of service attack.
14334
14335 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14336 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14337 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14338 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14339 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14340 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14341 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14342 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
14343 processed than on other servers.
14344
14345 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14346 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14347 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14348 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14349 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14350 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14351 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14352 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14353 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14354 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14355 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14356 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14357 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14358
14359 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14360 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14361 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14362 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14363 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14364 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14365 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14366 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14367
14368 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14369 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14370 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14371 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14372 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14373 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14374 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14375 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14376 occurs.
14377
14378 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
14379 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
14380 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
14381 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
14382 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
14383 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
14384 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
14385 cookies" below for more details.
14386
14387 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
14388 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
14389 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
14390 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
14391 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
14392 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
14393 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
14394 and cookies" below for more details.
14395
14396 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
14397 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
14398 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
14399 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
14400 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
14401 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
14402 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
14403 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
14404
14405
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200144068.2.4. Custom log format
14407------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014408
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014409The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014410mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014411
14412HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
14413Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
14414separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
14415prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
14416
14417Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
14418variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
14419string formats ("Q").
14420
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014421If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020014422as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014423less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
14424the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
14425
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014426Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014427In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010014428in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014429
14430Flags are :
14431 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014432 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014433
14434 Example:
14435
14436 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
14437 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
14438
14439At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
14440
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014441 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
14442 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014443
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014444the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014445
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014446 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020014447 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014448 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014449
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014450and the default TCP format is defined this way :
14451
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014452 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014453 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
14454
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014455Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
14456
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014457 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014458 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014459 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
14460 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
14461 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014462 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
14463 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
14464 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014465 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000014466 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
14467 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000014468 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000014469 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
14470 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014471 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020014472 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014473 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014474 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080014475 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014476 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
14477 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014478 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014479 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
14480 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014481 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014482 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
14483 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014484 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14485 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
14486 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014487 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014488 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
14489 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014490 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014491 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14492 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
14493 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020014494 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020014495 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020014496 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
14497 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
14498 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
14499 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020014500 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014501 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014502 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014503 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010014504 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014505 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014506 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
14507 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
14508 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014509 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014510 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
14511 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014512 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014513 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014514 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014515 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014516
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014517 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014518
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010014519
145208.2.5. Error log format
14521-----------------------
14522
14523When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
14524protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
14525By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
14526"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
14527will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
14528logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
14529
14530The format looks like this :
14531
14532 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
14533 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
14534 Connection error during SSL handshake
14535
14536 Field Format Extract from the example above
14537 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
14538 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
14539 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
14540 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
14541 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
14542
14543These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
14544failures.
14545
14546
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145478.3. Advanced logging options
14548-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014549
14550Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
14551just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
14552options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
14553for more information about their usage.
14554
14555
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145568.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
14557------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014558
14559It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
14560haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
14561commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
14562monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
14563ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
14564
14565 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
14566 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
14567 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
14568 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
14569
14570 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
14571 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
14572 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014573 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014574 such as other load-balancers.
14575
14576 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
14577 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
14578 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
14579
14580
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145818.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
14582----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014583
14584The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
14585what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
14586or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
14587"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
14588just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
14589log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
14590after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
14591is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
14592with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
14593with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
14594
14595
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145968.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
14597------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014598
14599Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
14600for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
14601"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
14602retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
14603raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
14604a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
14605file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
14606you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
14607"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
14608
14609
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146108.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
14611--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014612
14613Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
14614multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
14615them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
14616"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
14617logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
14618error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
14619and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
14620too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
14621useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
14622alternative.
14623
14624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146258.4. Timing events
14626------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014627
14628Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
14629reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
14630the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
14631frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
14632mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
14633
14634 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
14635 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
14636 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
14637 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
14638 the client closes prematurely or times out.
14639
14640 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
14641 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
14642 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
14643 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
14644 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
14645
14646 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
14647 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
14648 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
14649 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
14650 connection never established.
14651
14652 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
14653 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
14654 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
14655 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
14656 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
14657 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
14658 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
14659 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
14660 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
14661 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
14662 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
14663
14664 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
14665 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
14666 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
14667 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014668 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014669
14670 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
14671
14672 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
14673 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
14674 negative.
14675
14676These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
14677protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
14678that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014679due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014680close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
14681session has been aborted on timeout.
14682
14683Most common cases :
14684
14685 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
14686 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
14687 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
14688 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
14689 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
14690 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
14691 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
14692 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
14693 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020014694 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
14695 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
14696 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014697
14698 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
14699 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
14700 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
14701 of ms on remote networks.
14702
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014703 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
14704 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
14705 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014706
14707 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
14708 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
14709 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
14710 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
14711 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
14712 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
14713 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
14714 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
14715 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
14716 to the server until another one is released.
14717
14718Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
14719
14720 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
14721 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
14722 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
14723
14724 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
14725 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
14726 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
14727
14728 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
14729 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
14730 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
14731 flags.
14732
14733 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
14734 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
14735 Check the session termination flags, then check the
14736 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
14737 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
14738 the client connection was maintained open.
14739
14740 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014741 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014742 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
14743 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
14744
14745
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147468.5. Session state at disconnection
14747-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014748
14749TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
14750"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
147512-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
14752each of which has a special meaning :
14753
14754 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
14755 session to terminate :
14756
14757 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
14758
14759 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
14760 server explicitly refused it.
14761
14762 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
14763 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
14764 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
14765 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020014766 (eg: cacheable cookie).
14767
14768 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
14769 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014770
14771 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
14772 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
14773 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
14774 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
14775 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
14776
14777 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
14778 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
14779 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
14780 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
14781 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
14782
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090014783 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
14784 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
14785
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014786 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
14787 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
14788 backup connections when going up.
14789
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020014790 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
14791
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014792 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
14793 send or receive data.
14794
14795 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
14796 send or receive data.
14797
14798 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
14799 with nothing left in the buffers.
14800
14801 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
14802
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010014803 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014804 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
14805
14806 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
14807 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
14808 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
14809 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
14810 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
14811
14812 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
14813 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
14814
14815 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
14816 server (HTTP only).
14817
14818 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
14819
14820 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
14821 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
14822 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
14823
14824 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
14825 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
14826 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
14827
14828 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
14829
14830 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
14831 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
14832
14833 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
14834 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
14835 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
14836
14837 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
14838 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020014839 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
14840 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014841
14842 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
14843 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
14844 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
14845 another server.
14846
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014847 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014848 server.
14849
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014850 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
14851 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
14852 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
14853 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
14854
14855 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
14856 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
14857 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
14858 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
14859
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020014860 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
14861 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
14862 "use-server" rule).
14863
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014864 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
14865
14866 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
14867 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
14868
14869 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
14870
14871 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
14872 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
14873 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
14874
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014875 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
14876 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014877 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014878 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
14879 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
14880
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014881 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
14882
14883 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
14884 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
14885
14886 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
14887
14888 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
14889
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020014890The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
14891was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014892helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
14893starvation, attacks, etc...
14894
14895The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
14896alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
14897easier finding and understanding.
14898
14899 Flags Reason
14900
14901 -- Normal termination.
14902
14903 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
14904 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
14905 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
14906 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
14907
14908 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
14909 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
14910 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
14911 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
14912 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
14913 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014914
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014915 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
14916 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020014917 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014918
14919 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
14920 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
14921 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
14922
14923 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
14924 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
14925 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
14926 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
14927 the server takes too long to respond.
14928
14929 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
14930 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
14931 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
14932 long a time to respond.
14933
14934 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
14935 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
14936 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
14937 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014938 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
14939 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014940
14941 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
14942 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
14943 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
14944 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
14945 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020014946 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014947 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
14948 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
14949 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
14950 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
14951 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
14952 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
14953 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
14954 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
14955 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
14956 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
14957 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
14958 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014959
14960 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
14961 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014962 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
14963 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
14964 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
14965 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014966
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020014967 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
14968 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
14969
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014970 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014971 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
14972 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
14973 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
14974 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
14975 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
14976
14977 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
14978 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
14979 503 or 504 here.
14980
14981 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
14982 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
14983 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
14984 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
14985 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
14986
14987 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
14988 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014989 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014990 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
14991 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
14992
14993 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
14994 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
14995 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
14996 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
14997 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
14998 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
14999 between haproxy and the server.
15000
15001 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
15002 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
15003 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
15004 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
15005 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
15006 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
15007 solution is to fix the application.
15008
15009 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
15010 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
15011 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
15012 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
15013 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
15014 external attacks.
15015
15016 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
15017 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015018 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015019 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
15020 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
15021
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015022 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
15023 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
15024 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020015025 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
15026 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015027
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015028 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
15029 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
15030 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
15031 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015032 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
15033 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
15034 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
15035 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
15036 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015037
15038 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
15039 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
15040 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
15041 returned an HTTP 403 error.
15042
15043 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
15044 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
15045 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
15046 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
15047
15048 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
15049 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
15050 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
15051 only be solved by proper system tuning.
15052
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015053The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
15054persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
15055important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
15056re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
15057
15058 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
15059
15060 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15061 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
15062 set on a GET request.
15063
15064 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
15065 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015066 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015067 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
15068
15069 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
15070 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
15071 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
15072
15073 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15074 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
15075 already got a cookie.
15076
15077 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15078 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
15079 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
15080 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
15081 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
15082
15083 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15084 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15085 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15086
15087 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
15088 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15089 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15090
15091 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
15092 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
15093
15094 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
15095 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
15096 then advertised in the response.
15097
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015098
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150998.6. Non-printable characters
15100-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015101
15102In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
15103consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
15104converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
15105prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
15106being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
15107escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
15108is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
15109'}' when logging headers.
15110
15111Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
15112issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
15113containing spaces is "User-Agent".
15114
15115Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
15116the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
15117performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
15118
15119
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151208.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
15121---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015122
15123Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
15124achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015125section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015126cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
15127the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
15128the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015129locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015130not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
15131user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
15132a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
15133wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
15134
15135 Examples :
15136 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
15137 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
15138
15139 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
15140 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
15141
15142
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151438.8. Capturing HTTP headers
15144---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015145
15146Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
15147proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
15148the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
15149server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
15150
15151Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
15152response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015153section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015154
15155It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015156time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
15157appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015158are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
15159and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
15160follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
15161request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
15162in the logs.
15163
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015164As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
15165frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
15166an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
15167
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015168 Example :
15169 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
15170 listen proxy-out
15171 mode http
15172 option httplog
15173 option logasap
15174 log global
15175 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
15176
15177 # log the name of the virtual server
15178 capture request header Host len 20
15179
15180 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
15181 capture request header Content-Length len 10
15182
15183 # log the beginning of the referrer
15184 capture request header Referer len 20
15185
15186 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
15187 capture response header Server len 20
15188
15189 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
15190 capture response header Content-Length len 10
15191
15192 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
15193 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
15194
15195 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
15196 capture response header Via len 20
15197
15198 # log the URL location during a redirection
15199 capture response header Location len 20
15200
15201 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
15202 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
15203 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15204 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
15205 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
15206
15207 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15208 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15209 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15210 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015211 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015212
15213 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15214 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15215 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15216 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
15217 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015218 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015219
15220
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152218.9. Examples of logs
15222---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015223
15224These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
15225them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
15226reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
15227
15228 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
15229 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15230 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15231
15232 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
15233 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
15234
15235 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
15236 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
15237 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15238
15239 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
15240 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
15241
15242 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
15243 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15244 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
15245
15246 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015247 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015248 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
15249 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
15250
15251 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
15252 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
15253 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
15254
15255 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
15256 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020015257 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015258 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
15259 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
15260 to return the 502 and not the server.
15261
15262 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015263 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015264
15265 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
15266 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
15267 Nothing was sent to any server.
15268
15269 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
15270 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
15271
15272 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
15273 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
15274 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
15275 send a 408 return code to the client.
15276
15277 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
15278 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
15279
15280 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
15281 5 seconds ("c----").
15282
15283 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
15284 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015285 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015286
15287 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015288 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015289 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
15290 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
15291 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
15292 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
15293 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015294
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015295
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152969. Statistics and monitoring
15297----------------------------
15298
15299It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
15300mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
15301CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
15302Unix socket.
15303
15304
153059.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015306---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010015307
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010015308The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020015309page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
15310begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
15311represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
15312use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
15313('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
15314(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
15315text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
15316do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
15317use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010015318
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040015319In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
15320that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
15321S (Servers).
15322
15323 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
15324 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
15325 any name for server/listener)
15326 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
15327 number queued without a server assigned.
15328 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
15329 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
15330 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
15331 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
15332 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
15333 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
15334 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
15335 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
15336 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
15337 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
15338 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
15339 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
15340 "option checkcache".
15341 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
15342 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
15343 - read error from the client
15344 - client timeout
15345 - client closed connection
15346 - various bad requests from the client.
15347 - request was tarpitted.
15348 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
15349 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
15350 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
15351 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
15352 active servers).
15353 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
15354 Some other errors are:
15355 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
15356 - failure applying filters to the response.
15357 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
15358 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
15359 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
15360 switched away from.
15361 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Pavlos Parissis1f673c72015-05-02 20:30:44 +020015362 18. weight [..BS]: total weight (backend), server weight (server)
15363 19. act [..BS]: number of active servers (backend), server is active (server)
15364 20. bck [..BS]: number of backup servers (backend), server is backup (server)
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040015365 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
15366 the server is up.)
15367 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
15368 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
15369 counters for each server.
15370 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
15371 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
15372 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
15373 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
15374 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
15375 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
15376 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
15377 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
15378 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
15379 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
15380 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
15381 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
15382 of times that server was selected.
15383 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
15384 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
15385 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
15386 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
15387 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
15388 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010015389 UNK -> unknown
15390 INI -> initializing
15391 SOCKERR -> socket error
15392 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
Jason Harvey83104802015-04-16 11:13:21 -080015393 L4TOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010015394 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
15395 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
15396 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
15397 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
15398 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
15399 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
15400 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
15401 disable-on-404
15402 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
15403 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
15404 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040015405 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
15406 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
15407 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
15408 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
15409 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
15410 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
15411 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
15412 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
15413 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
15414 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
15415 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
15416 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
15417 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
15418 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
15419 (inc. in eresp)
15420 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
15421 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
15422 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
15423 (CPU/BW limit)
15424 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
15425 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
15426 server/backend
15427 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
15428 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
15429 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
15430 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
15431 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
15432 (0 for TCP)
15433 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
15434 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015435
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200154379.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015438-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010015439
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020015440The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
15441necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
15442A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
15443issuing commands by hand :
15444
15445 global
15446 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
15447 stats timeout 2m
15448
15449It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
15450the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
15451never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
15452situations :
15453
15454 global
15455 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
15456 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
15457 stats timeout 2m
15458
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015459To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is
15460a swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect
15461terminals to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts.
15462The two main syntaxes we'll use are the following :
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020015463
15464 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
15465 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
15466
15467The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
15468script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
15469for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
15470
15471The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
15472that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
15473editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
15474(eg: watch a counter).
15475
15476The socket supports two operation modes :
15477 - interactive
15478 - non-interactive
15479
15480The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
15481this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
15482sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
15483mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
15484commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
15485example :
15486
15487 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
15488
15489The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
15490entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
15491for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
15492sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
15493"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
15494after processing the last command of the same line.
15495
15496For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
15497"prompt" command :
15498
15499 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
15500 prompt
15501 > show info
15502 ...
15503 >
15504
15505Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
15506delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
15507that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
15508parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015509
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015510It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
15511on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
15512own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015513
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020015514The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
15515If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
15516all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
15517it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
15518
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015519add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015520 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
15521 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
15522 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
15523 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015524
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015525add map <map> <key> <value>
15526 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
15527 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015528 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
15529 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
15530 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015531
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015532clear counters
15533 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
15534 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
15535 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
15536 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
15537 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
15538
15539clear counters all
15540 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
15541 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
15542 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
15543
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015544clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015545 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
15546 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
15547 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015548
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015549clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015550 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
15551 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
15552 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015553
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090015554clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
15555 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
15556
15557 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
15558 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
15559 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
15560 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
15561 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
15562 later after the session ends is usual enough.
15563
15564 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
15565
15566 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
15567 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
15568 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
15569 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
15570 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
15571 the ACLs :
15572
15573 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
15574 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
15575 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
15576 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
15577 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
15578 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
15579
15580 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090015581 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
15582 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015583
15584 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015585 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020015586 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015587 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
15588 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
15589 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15590 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015591
15592 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15593
15594 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020015595 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015596 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
15597 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090015598 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15599 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15600 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020015601
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015602del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
15603 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015604 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
15605 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
15606 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
15607 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015608
15609del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010015610 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015611 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
15612 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
15613 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
15614 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010015615
15616disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090015617 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
15618
15619 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
15620 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
15621 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
15622 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
15623 re-enabled using enable agent.
15624
15625 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
15626 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
15627 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
15628 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
15629 otherwise unchanged.
15630
15631 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
15632 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
15633 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
15634
15635 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15636 level "admin".
15637
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020015638disable frontend <frontend>
15639 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
15640 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
15641 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
15642 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
15643 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
15644 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
15645 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
15646 on the stats page.
15647
15648 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
15649 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15650
15651 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15652 level "admin".
15653
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020015654disable health <backend>/<server>
15655 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
15656 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
15657 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
15658 agent check forces it down.
15659
15660 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15661 level "admin".
15662
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015663disable server <backend>/<server>
15664 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
15665 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
15666 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
15667 during the maintenance.
15668
15669 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
15670 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
15671
15672 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020015673 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015674
15675 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15676 level "admin".
15677
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090015678enable agent <backend>/<server>
15679 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
15680
15681 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
15682 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
15683
15684 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15685 level "admin".
15686
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020015687enable frontend <frontend>
15688 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
15689 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
15690 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
15691 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
15692 which was disabled.
15693
15694 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
15695 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15696
15697 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15698 level "admin".
15699
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020015700enable health <backend>/<server>
15701 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
15702 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
15703
15704 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15705 level "admin".
15706
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015707enable server <backend>/<server>
15708 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
15709 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
15710
15711 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020015712 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015713
15714 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
15715 level "admin".
15716
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010015717get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015718get acl <acl> <value>
15719 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
15720 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
15721 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
15722 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
15723 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010015724
15725 The first two words are:
15726
15727 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
15728 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
15729 "dom", "end" or "reg".
15730
15731 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
15732
15733 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
15734
15735 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
15736
15737 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
15738 interpretation of the case.
15739
15740 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
15741 useful with regular expressions.
15742
15743 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
15744 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
15745
15746 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
15747 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
15748 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
15749
15750 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
15751
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015752get weight <backend>/<server>
15753 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
15754 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
15755 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
15756 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
15757 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020015758 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015759
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015760help
15761 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
15762 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010015763
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015764prompt
15765 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
15766 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
15767 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
15768 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
15769 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
15770 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
15771 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
15772 command.
15773
15774quit
15775 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010015776
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015777set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015778 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
15779 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
15780 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015781
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020015782set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020015783 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
15784 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
15785 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
15786 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
15787 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020015788 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
15789 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
15790
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020015791set maxconn global <maxconn>
15792 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
15793 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
15794 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
15795 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
15796 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
15797 setting.
15798
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020015799set rate-limit connections global <value>
15800 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
15801 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
15802 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
15803 is passed in number of connections per second.
15804
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010015805set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
15806 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
15807 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010015808 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
15809 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010015810
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020015811set rate-limit sessions global <value>
15812 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
15813 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
15814 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
15815 is passed in number of sessions per second.
15816
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020015817set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
15818 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
15819 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
15820 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
15821 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
15822 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
15823
Baptiste Assmann3d8f8312015-04-13 22:54:33 +020015824set server <backend>/<server> addr <ip4 or ip6 address>
15825 Replace the current IP address of a server by the one provided.
15826
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020015827set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
15828 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
15829 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
15830 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
15831
15832set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
15833 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
15834 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
15835 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
15836
15837set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
15838 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
15839 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
15840 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
15841 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
15842 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
15843 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
15844 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
15845 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
15846
15847set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
15848 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
15849 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
15850
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020015851set ssl ocsp-response <response>
15852 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
15853 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
15854 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
15855 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
15856
15857 Example:
15858 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
15859 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
15860 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
15861 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
15862
Nenad Merdanovicc6985f02015-05-09 08:46:02 +020015863set ssl tls-key <id> <tlskey>
15864 Set the next TLS key for the <id> listener to <tlskey>. This key becomes the
15865 ultimate key, while the penultimate one is used for encryption (others just
15866 decrypt). The oldest TLS key present is overwritten. <id> is either a numeric
15867 #<id> or <file> returned by "show tls-keys". <tlskey> is a base64 encoded 48
15868 bit TLS ticket key (ex. openssl rand -base64 48).
15869
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020015870set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020015871 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
15872 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
15873 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
15874 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020015875 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
15876 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020015877
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015878set timeout cli <delay>
15879 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
15880 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
15881 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
15882
15883set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
15884 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
15885 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090015886 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
15887 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
15888 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
15889 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
15890 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
15891 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
15892 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
15893 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
15894 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
15895 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
15896 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
15897 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
15898 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015899
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015900show errors [<iid>]
15901 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
15902 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020015903 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
15904 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
15905 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015906
15907 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
15908 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
15909 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
15910 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
15911 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
15912 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
15913 are reported too.
15914
15915 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
15916 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
15917 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
15918 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
15919 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
15920 code.
15921
15922 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
15923 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
15924 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
15925 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
15926 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
15927 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
15928 line.
15929
15930 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020015931 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
15932 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015933 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
15934 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
15935
15936 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
15937 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
15938 00038 Location: blah\r\n
15939 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
15940 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
15941 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
15942 00204+ minal\r\n
15943 00211 \r\n
15944
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015945 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010015946 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
15947 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
15948 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
15949 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
15950 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
15951 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010015952
Baptiste Assmann9b6857e2015-09-18 14:49:12 +020015953show backend
15954 Dump the list of backends available in the running process
15955
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020015956show info
15957 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
15958
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015959show map [<map>]
15960 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015961 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
15962 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
15963 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
15964 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
15965 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
15966 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010015967
15968show acl [<acl>]
15969 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010015970 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
15971 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
15972 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
15973 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
15974 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010015975
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010015976show pools
15977 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
15978 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
15979 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
15980 the pools.
15981
Baptiste Assmann6f9225a2015-05-08 19:35:08 +020015982show servers state [<backend>]
15983 Dump the state of the servers found in the running configuration. A backend
15984 name or identifier may be provided to limit the output to this backend only.
15985
15986 The dump has the following format:
15987 - first line contains the format version (1 in this specification);
15988 - second line contains the column headers, prefixed by a sharp ('#');
15989 - third line and next ones contain data;
15990 - each line starting by a sharp ('#') is considered as a comment.
15991
15992 Since multiple versions of the ouptput may co-exist, below is the list of
15993 fields and their order per file format version :
15994 1:
15995 be_id: Backend unique id.
15996 be_name: Backend label.
15997 srv_id: Server unique id (in the backend).
15998 srv_name: Server label.
15999 srv_addr: Server IP address.
16000 srv_op_state: Server operational state (UP/DOWN/...).
16001 In source code: SRV_ST_*.
16002 srv_admin_state: Server administrative state (MAINT/DRAIN/...).
16003 In source code: SRV_ADMF_*.
16004 srv_uweight: User visible server's weight.
16005 srv_iweight: Server's initial weight.
16006 srv_time_since_last_change: Time since last operational change.
16007 srv_check_status: Last health check status.
16008 srv_check_result: Last check result (FAILED/PASSED/...).
16009 In source code: CHK_RES_*.
16010 srv_check_health: Checks rise / fall current counter.
16011 srv_check_state: State of the check (ENABLED/PAUSED/...).
16012 In source code: CHK_ST_*.
16013 srv_agent_state: State of the agent check (ENABLED/PAUSED/...).
16014 In source code: CHK_ST_*.
16015 bk_f_forced_id: Flag to know if the backend ID is forced by
16016 configuration.
16017 srv_f_forced_id: Flag to know if the server's ID is forced by
16018 configuration.
16019
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020016020show sess
16021 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020016022 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
16023 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
16024
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010016025show sess <id>
16026 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
16027 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
16028 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
16029 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
16030 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Olivierce31e6e2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020016031 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
16032 returned in src/dumpstats.c
16033
16034 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
16035 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020016036
16037show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
16038 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
16039 possible to dump only selected items :
16040 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
16041 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
16042 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
16043 for example:
16044 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
16045 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
16046 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
16047
16048 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020016049 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
16050 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020016051 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
16052 Release_date: 2009/09/23
16053 Nbproc: 1
16054 Process_num: 1
16055 (...)
16056
16057 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
16058 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
16059 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
16060 (...)
16061 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
16062
16063 $
16064
16065 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
16066 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
16067 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
16068 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016069 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020016070
Andrew Hayworth68d05342015-10-02 20:33:01 +000016071show stat resolvers [<resolvers section id>]
16072 Dump statistics for the given resolvers section, or all resolvers sections
16073 if no section is supplied.
16074
Baptiste Assmann3863f972015-05-17 00:33:24 +020016075 For each name server, the following counters are reported:
16076 sent: number of DNS requests sent to this server
16077 valid: number of DNS valid responses received from this server
16078 update: number of DNS responses used to update the server's IP address
16079 cname: number of CNAME responses
16080 cname_error: CNAME errors encountered with this server
16081 any_err: number of empty response (IE: server does not support ANY type)
16082 nx: non existent domain response received from this server
16083 timeout: how many time this server did not answer in time
16084 refused: number of requests refused by this server
16085 other: any other DNS errors
16086 invalid: invalid DNS response (from a protocol point of view)
16087 too_big: too big response
16088 outdated: number of response arrived too late (after an other name server)
16089
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020016090show table
16091 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
16092 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
16093 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
16094 entries currently in use.
16095
16096 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020016097 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090016098 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
16099 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020016100
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090016101show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020016102 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
16103 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
16104 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090016105 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
16106
16107 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
16108 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
16109 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
16110 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
16111 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
16112
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020016113 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
16114 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
16115 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
16116 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
16117 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
16118 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
16119
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090016120
16121 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090016122 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
16123 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090016124
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020016125 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020016126 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090016127 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020016128 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
16129 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
16130 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
16131 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020016132
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020016133 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090016134 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020016135 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
16136 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020016137
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020016138 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
16139 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090016140 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020016141 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
16142 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020016143
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090016144 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
16145 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090016146 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090016147 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
16148 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
16149
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020016150 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
16151 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
16152 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
16153 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
16154 time goes, the average event rate drops.
16155
16156 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
16157 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
16158 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020016159 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
16160 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020016161 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
16162 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020016163
Nenad Merdanovicc6985f02015-05-09 08:46:02 +020016164show tls-keys
16165 Dump all loaded TLS ticket keys. The TLS ticket key reference ID and the
16166 file from which the keys have been loaded is shown. Both of those can be
16167 used to update the TLS keys using "set ssl tls-key".
16168
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020016169shutdown frontend <frontend>
16170 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
16171 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
16172 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
16173 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
16174 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
16175 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
16176 once it is terminated.
16177
16178 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
16179 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
16180
16181 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
16182 level "admin".
16183
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020016184shutdown session <id>
16185 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
16186 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
16187 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
16188 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
16189 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
16190 flag in the logs.
16191
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020016192shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016193 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
16194 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
16195 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
16196 'K' flag in the logs.
16197
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016198/*
16199 * Local variables:
16200 * fill-column: 79
16201 * End:
16202 */